GE Fanuc Automation: Series 16i / 18i / 160i / 180i - Model A
GE Fanuc Automation: Series 16i / 18i / 160i / 180i - Model A
GE Fanuc Automation: Series 16i / 18i / 160i / 180i - Model A
Maintenance Manual
this publication
Warning
In this manual we have tried as much as possible to describe all the various
matters. However, we cannot describe all the matters which must not be done,
or which cannot be done, because there are so many possibilities.
Therefore, matters which are not especially described as possible in this
manual should be regarded as “impossible”.
Notice
This document is based on information available at the time of its publication. While efforts have
been made to be accurate, the information contained herein does not purport to cover all details or
variations in hardware or software, nor to provide every contingency in connection with
installation, operation, or maintenance. Features may be described herein which are not present in
all hardware and software systems. GE Fanuc Automation assumes no obligation of notice to
holders of this document with respect to changes subsequently made.
CIMPLICITY® Genius®
This manual includes safety precautions for protecting the user and preventing damage to the
machine. Precautions are classified into Warning and Caution according to their bearing on safety.
Also, supplementary information is described as a Note. Read the Warning, Caution, and Note
thoroughly before attempting to use the machine.
WARNING
Applied when there is a danger of the user being injured or when there is a damage of both the user
being injured and the equipment being damaged if the approved procedure is not observed.
CAUTION
Applied when there is a danger of the equipment being damaged, if the approved procedure is not
observed.
NOTE
The Note is used to indicate supplementary information other than Warning and Caution.
s–1
B–63005EN/01 PREFACE
PREFACE
2.Hardware
3.Data input/output
5.Digital servo
This chapter describes the servo tuning screen and how to adjust the
reference position return position.
6.AC spindles
7.Trouble shooting
APPENDIX
This manual can be used with the following models. The abbreviated
names may be used.
p–1
PREFACE B–63005EN/01
NOTE
Some function described in this manual may not be applied
to some products.
For details, refer to the DESCRIPTIONS manual
(B–63002EN)
p–2
B–63005EN/01 PREFACE
Related manuals The table below lists manuals related to MODEL A of Series 16i, Series
18i, Series 160i and Series 180i.
In the table, this manual is marked with an asterisk(*).
p–3
PREFACE B–63005EN/01
D Specification
FANUC AC SERVO MOTOR α series D Characteristics
B–65142E
DESCRIPTIONS D External dimensions
D Connections D Selection of motor
D Specification D Connection of motor
D Initial setting
FANUC AC SERVO MOTOR α series
B–65150E D Setting parameters
PARAMETER MANUAL D Start up the system
D Description of parameters (Software)
p–4
B–63005EN/01 Table of Contents
DEFINITION OF WARNING, CAUTION, AND NOTE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . s–1
PREFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . p–1
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
1.1 FUNCTION KEYS AND SOFT KEYS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
1.1.1 Soft Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
1.2 SCREEN DISPLAYED IMMEDIATELY AFTER POWER IS TURNED ON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
1.2.1 Slot Status Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
1.2.2 Setting Module Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
1.2.3 Configuration Display of Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
1.3 SYSTEM CONFIGURATION SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
1.3.1 Display Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
1.3.2 Configuration of PCBs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
1.3.3 Software Configuration Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
1.3.4 Module Configuration Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
1.4 ALARM HISTORY SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
1.4.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
1.4.2 Screen Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
1.4.3 Clearing Alarm History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
1.4.4 Alarm Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
1.5 EXTERNAL OPERATOR MESSAGES RECORD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
1.5.1 Screen Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
1.5.2 Deletion of External Operator Messages Record . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
1.5.3 Parameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
1.5.4 Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
1.6 OPERATION HISTORY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
1.6.1 Parameter Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
1.6.2 Screen Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
1.6.3 Setting The Input Signal or Output Signal to Be Recorded in The Operation History . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
1.6.4 Inputting and Outputting the Operation History Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
1.6.5 Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
1.7 HELP FUNCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
1.7.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
1.7.2 Display Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
1.8 DISPLAYING DIAGNOSTIC PAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
1.8.1 Displaying Diagnostic Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
1.8.2 Contents Displayed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
1.9 CNC STATE DISPLAY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
1.10 WAVE FORM DIAGNOSTIC FUNCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
1.10.1 Setting Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
1.10.2 Waveform Diagnostic Parameter Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
1.10.3 Graphic of Wave Diagnosis data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
1.10.4 Data Sampling for Storage Type Waveform Diagnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
1.10.5 Outputting Waveform Diagnosis Data (Storage Type) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
1.10.6 Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
1.11 OPERATING MONITOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
1.11.1 Display Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
1.11.2 Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
1.12 LIST OF OPERATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
1.13 WARNING SCREEN DISPLAYED WHEN AN OPTION IS CHANGED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
c–1
Table of Contents B–63005EN/01
2. HARDWARE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
2.1 STRUCTURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
2.2 OVERVIEW OF HARDWARE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
2.2.1 Series 16i/160i . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
2.2.2 Series 18i/180i . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
2.3 CONFIGURATION OF PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD CONNECTORS AND CARDS . . . . . . . . . 116
2.3.1 FS16i/18i Motherboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
2.3.2 FS160i/180i Motherboard with the PC Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
2.3.3 Inverter P.C.B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
2.3.4 C language Board, Serial Communication Board, CAP–II Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
2.3.5 Sub–CPU Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
2.3.6 RISC Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
2.3.7 Data Server Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
2.3.8 Loader Control Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
2.3.9 HSSB Interface Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
2.4 LIST OF UNITS AND PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARDS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
2.4.1 Basic Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
2.4.2 MDI Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
2.4.3 Printed Circuit Boards of the Control Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
2.4.4 Others . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
2.5 REPLACING THE MOTHERBOARD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
2.6 MOUNTING AND DEMOUNTING CARD PCBS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
2.6.1 Demounting a Card PCB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
2.6.2 Mounting a Card PCB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
2.7 MOUNTING AND DEMOUNTING DIMM MODULES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
2.7.1 Demounting a DIMM Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
2.7.2 Mounting a DIMM module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
2.8 REPLACING FUSE ON CONTROL UNIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
2.9 REPLACING BATTERY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
2.10 REPLACING FAN MOTORS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
2.11 REPLACING LCD BACKLIGHT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
2.12 MAINTENANCE OF HEAT EXCHANGER OF HEAT PIPE TYPE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
2.13 ENVIRONMENTAL CONDITIONS OUTSIDE CABINET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
2.14 POWER CONSUMPTION OF EACH UNIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
c–2
B–63005EN/01 Table of Contents
c–3
Table of Contents B–63005EN/01
7. TROUBLESHOOTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303
7.1 CORRECTIVE ACTION FOR FAILURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304
7.1.1 Investigating the Conditions under which Failure Occurred . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304
7.2 NO MANUAL OPERATION NOR AUTOMATIC OPERATION CAN BE EXECUTED . . . . . . . . 306
7.3 JOG OPERATION CANNOT BE DONE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 310
7.4 HANDLE OPERATION CANNOT BE DONE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
7.5 AUTOMATIC OPERATION CANNOT BE DONE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
7.6 CYCLE START LED SIGNAL HAS TURNED OFF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325
7.7 NO DISPLAY APPEARS AT POWER–UP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327
c–4
B–63005EN/01 Table of Contents
APPENDIX
A. ALARM LIST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363
A.1 LIST OF ALARM CODES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364
A.2 LIST OF ALARMS (PMC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 394
A.3 SPINDLE ALARMS (SERIAL SPINDLE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 404
c–5
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
1
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
1.1 Operations and soft key display staturs for each function key are described
below:
FUNCTION KEYS
AND SOFT KEYS
1.1.1 To display a more detailed screen, press a function key followed by a soft
Soft Keys key. Soft keys are also used for actual operations.
The following illustrates how soft key displays are changed by pressing
each function key.
The symbols in the following figures mean as shown below :
: Indicates screens
*1 Press function keys to switch between screens that are used frequently.
*2 Some soft keys are not displayed depending on the option configuration.
*3 In some cases, the continuous menu key is omitted when the 12 soft keys
type is used.
2
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
POSITION SCREEN Soft key transition triggered by the function key POS
POS
[RUNPRE] [EXEC]
[ORIGIN] [ALLEXE]
[RUNPRE] [EXEC]
[ORIGIN] [ALLEXE]
[RUNPRE] [EXEC]
Handle interruption
[RUNPRE] [EXEC]
Monitor screen
[RUNPRE] [EXEC]
3
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
PROGRAM SCREEN Soft key transition triggered by the function key PROG
1/2
PROG
[PRGRM] [(OPRT)] [BG–EDT] See “When the soft key [BG–EDT] is pressed”
[O number] [O SRH]
[N number] [N SRH]
[REWIND]
[P TYPE]
[Q TYPE]
[F SRH] [CAN]
[EXEC]
[CHECK] [ABS] [(OPRT)] [BG–EDT] See “When the soft key [BG–EDT] is pressed”
[REL] [O number] [O SRH]
[N number] [N SRH]
[REWIND]
[P TYPE]
[Q TYPE]
[F SRH] [CAN]
[EXEC]
[CURRNT] [(OPRT)] [BG–EDT] See “When the soft key [BG–EDT] is pressed”
[NEXT] [(OPRT)] [BG–EDT] See “When the soft key [BG–EDT] is pressed”
[RSTR] [(OPRT)] [BG–EDT] See “When the soft key [BG–EDT] is pressed”
4
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
2/2
(2)
5
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
PROGRAM SCREEN Soft key transition triggered by the function key PROG
1/2
PROG
Program display
[PRGRM] [(OPRT)] [BG–EDT] See “When the soft key [BG–EDT] is pressed”
(O number) [O SRH]
(Address) [SRH↓]
(Address) [SRH↑]
[REWIND]
[F SRH] [CAN]
(N number) [EXEC]
[READ] [CHAIN] (The cursor moves to the end of a program.)
[STOP]
[CAN]
(O number) [EXEC]
[PUNCH] [STOP]
[CAN]
(O number) [EXEC]
[DELETE] [CAN]
(N number) [EXEC]
[EX–EDT] [COPY] [CRSR∼] (O number) [EXEC]
[∼CRSR]
[∼BTTM]
[ALL]
[MOVE] [CRSR∼] (O number) [EXEC]
[∼CRSR]
[∼BTTM]
[ALL]
[MERGE] [∼CRSR] (O number) [EXEC]
[∼BTTM]
[CHANGE] (Address) [BEFORE]
6
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
2/2
(1)
[LIB] [(OPRT)] [BG–EDT] See “When the soft key [BG–EDT] is pressed”
(O number) [O SRH] Return to the program
[READ] [CHAIN]
[STOP]
[CAN]
(O number) [EXEC]
[PUNCH] [STOP]
[CAN]
(O number) [EXEC]
7
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
PROGRAM SCREEN Soft key transition triggered by the function key PROG
PROG
Program display
[PRGRM] [(OPRT)] [BG–EDT] See “When the soft key [BG–EDT] is pressed”
[MDI] [(OPRT)] [BG–EDT] See “When the soft key [BG–EDT] is pressed”
[START] [CAN]
[EXEC]
(Address) [SRH↓]
(Address) [SRH↑]
[REWIND]
[CURRNT] [(OPRT)] [BG–EDT] See When the soft key [BG-EDT] is pressed"
[NEXT] [(OPRT)] [BG–EDT] See “When the soft key [BG–EDT] is pressed”
[RSTR] [(OPRT)] [BG–EDT] See “When the soft key [BG–EDT] is pressed”
8
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
PROGRAM SCREEN Soft key transition triggered by the function key PROG
PROG
Program display
[PRGRM] [(OPRT)] [BG–EDT] See “When the soft key [BG–EDT] is pressed”
[CURRNT] [(OPRT)] [BG–EDT] See “When the soft key [BG–EDT] is pressed”
[NEXT] [(OPRT)] [BG–EDT] See “When the soft key [BG–EDT] is pressed”
[RSTR] [(OPRT)] [BG–EDT] See “When the soft key [BG–EDT] is pressed”
9
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
PROGRAM SCREEN Soft key transition triggered by the function key PROG
PROG
Program display
[PRGRM] [(OPRT)] [BG–EDT] See “When the soft key [BG–EDT] is pressed”
[MDI] [(OPRT)] [BG–EDT] See “When the soft key [BG–EDT] is pressed”
(O number) [O SRH] Return to the program
(Address) [SRH↓]
(Address) [SRH↑]
[REWIND]
[LIB] [(OPRT)] [BG–EDT] See “When the soft key [BG–EDT] is pressed”
(O number) [O SRH] Return to the program
10
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
PROG
PROGRAM SCREEN Soft key transition triggered by the function key
(When the soft key [BG–EDT] is pressed in all modes)
1/2
PROG
Program display
[F SRH] [CAN]
(N number) [EXEC]
[READ] [CHAIN] (The cursor moves to the end of a program.)
[STOP]
[CAN]
(O number) [EXEC]
[PUNCH] [STOP]
[CAN]
(O number) [EXEC]
[DELETE] [CAN]
(N number) [EXEC]
[EX–EDT] [COPY] [CRSR∼] (O number) [EXEC]
[∼CRSR]
[∼BTTM]
[ALL]
[MOVE] [CRSR∼] (O number) [EXEC]
[∼CRSR]
[∼BTTM]
[ALL]
[MERGE] [∼CRSR] (O number) [EXEC]
[∼BTTM]
[CHANGE] (Address) [BEFORE]
11
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
2/2
(1)
[READ] [CHAIN]
[STOP]
[CAN]
(O number) [EXEC]
[PUNCH] [STOP]
[CAN]
(O number) [EXEC]
12
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
1/2
OFFSET
SETTING
[CLEAR] [ALL]
[WEAR]
[GEOM]
[READ] [CAN]
[EXEC]
[PUNCH] [CAN]
[EXEC]
Setting screen
[PUNCH] [CAN]
[EXEC]
13
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
2/2
(1)
[OPR]
[CLEAR] [ALL]
[WEAR]
[GEOM]
[READ] [CAN]
[EXEC]
[PUNCH] [CAN]
[EXEC]
[OFST.B]
14
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
OFFSET
SETTING
Setting screen
[PUNCH]
[OPR]
15
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
SYSTEM SCREEN Soft key transition triggered by the function key SYSTEM
1/3
SYSTEM
Parameter screen
[READ] [CAN]
[EXEC]
[PUNCH] [CAN]
To enter a file number: Press N , enter a file
[EXEC]
number, then press INPUT
on the PRGRM screen
Diagnosis screen
PMC screen
[F–SRCH]
[ADRESS]/[SYMBOL]
[TRIGER] [TRGON]
[TRGOFF]
[START]
[DUMP] [SEARCH]
[DPARA]/[NDPARA] [BYTE]
[TRGSRC] [WORD]
[INIT] [D.WORD]
[WINDOW] [DIVIDE]
[CANCEL]
[DELETE]
[SELECT]
[WIDTH]
(1) (2) (3)
(Continued on the next page)
16
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
[BYTE]
[WORD]
[D.WORD]
[DRARA]/[NDPARA]
[PMCDGN] [TITLE]
[STATUS] [SEARCH]
[ALARM]
[TRACE] [T.DISP]/[TRCPRM]
[EXEC]
[M.SRCH] [SEARCH]
[INPUT]
[ANALYS] [SCOPE] [SGNPRM]
With [DELETE] [START]/[STOP]
PMC–RC [INIT] [T–SRCH]
only
[ADRESS]/[SYMBOL]
[EXCHG] [SELECT] [TO] [EXEC]
[CANCEL]
[ADRESS]/[SYMBOL]
[PMCPRM] [TIMER]
[COUNTR]
[KEEPRL]
[DATA] [G.DATA] [C.DATA]
[G.CONT] [G–SRCH]
[NO.SRH] [SEARCH]
[INIT]
[SETTING] [YES]/[MANUAL]/[ROM]
[NO]/[AUTO]/[RAM]
[STOP]/[RUN]
[I/O] [EXEC]
[CANCEL]
(No.)
[SPEED] [INPUT]
[INIT]
[MDI]/[ROM]
[SYSTEM]
(4)
(Continued on the next page)
17
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
(4) 3/3
Pitch error compensation screen
[READ] [CAN]
[EXEC]
[PUNCH] [CAN]
To enter a file number: Press N , enter a file
[EXEC]
number, then press INPUT
on the PRGRM screen
[W.DGNS] [W.PRM]
[W.GRPH] [STSRT]
[TIME→]
[←TIME]
[H–DOBL]
[H–HALF]
[STSRT]
[CH–1↑]
[CH–1↓]
[V–DOBL]
[V–HALF]
[STSRT]
[CH–2↑]
[CH–2↓]
[V–DOBL]
[V–HALF]
18
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
MESSAGE SCREEN Soft key transition triggered by the function key MESSAGE
MESSAGE
[ALARM]
[MSG]
HELP SCREEN Soft key transition triggered by the function key HELP
HELP
[PARAM]
19
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
GRAPHIC SCREEN (T series) Soft key transition triggered by the function key GRAPH
Mode 0 GRAPH
A.ST/Path graphics
Mode 1 to 3 GRAPH
A.ST/Path graphics
[SIDE]
[FRONT]
[OPEN]
[ZOOM] [(OPRT)] [EXEC]
[HI/LO]
20
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
GRAPHIC SCREEN (M series) Soft key transition triggered by the function key GRAPH
GRAPH
[PARAM]
Solid graphics
GRAPH
Solid graphics
[PARAM]
[PARAM]
[3–PLN] [(OPRT)] [ ]
[←]
[→]
[↑]
[↓]
21
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
1.2
SCREEN DISPLAYED
IMMEDIATELY AFTER
POWER IS TURNED
ON
1.2.1
Slot Status Display Types of PCBs mounted on the slots are displayed.
If a hardware trouble or an incorrect mounting is found, this screen is
displayed.
0: 003E4000 0:
1: 30464202 1:
2: 00504303 2:
3: 3:
4: 4:
5: 5:
… …
D Module ID
ID Name
D5 Series 16i motherboard
C5 Series 18i motherboard
CC Series 160i motherboard
EC Series 180i motherboard
CD Serial communication board: remote buffer/DNC2
Serial communication board: DNC1
C language board
CAP II board
CE Sub–CPU board
CF RISC board
A3 Data server board
22
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
ID Name
D3 Loader control board
AA HSSB interface board
C9 PC function card
1.2.2
Setting Module Screen
END : Setting
B0F1–01 completed
1.2.3
Configuration Display
of Software
CNC control
B0F1–01 software
PMC
23
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
1.3 After the system has been installed correctly, you can find the PCBs
installed and the softwares integrated on the system configuration screen.
SYSTEM
CONFIGURATION
SCREEN
1.3.2
Configuration of PCBs
D Screen
Software series of mod-
ule with CPU
Software ID (type)
Module ID
Slot No.
(80X8F is 2nd side)
24
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
D Module ID
ID Name
D5 Series 16i motherboard
C5 Series 18i motherboard
CC Series 160i motherboard
EC Series 180i motherboard
CD Serial communication board: remote buffer/DNC2
Serial communication board: DNC1
C language board
CAP–II board
CE Sub–CPU board
CF RISC board
A3 Data server board
D3 Loader control board
AA HSSB interface board
C9 PC function card
25
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
1.3.3
Kind of software
Software Configuration Software series
Screen
SYSTEM CONFIG (SOFTWARE) 01234 N12345
PAGE:02
SYSTEM B0F0 0001 Software version
BASIC+OPTION–A1 Software
SERVO 9090 0001 configuration
PMC(SYS) 406A 0001
406B 0001
4099 0001
PMC(LAD) FS16 0001 Character written
MACRO LIB BZG1 0001 on PMC title screen
MACRO APL AAAA BBBB Character written
BOOT 60M3 0004 on macro compiler
GRAPHIC–1 600W 001Z or on CAP.
(3)
MEM **** *** *** 12:14:59
[ PARMA ][ DGNOS ][ PMC ][ SYSTEM ][(OPRT)]
Contents of display
(1) Slot number (The number is corresponding to PCB configuration
screen)
(2) Type of PCB mounted
(3) Name of card PCB or DIMM module
(4) Hardware ID of mounted card PCB or DIMM module
Refer to “2.4.3 Printed Circuit Boards of the Control Unit” for
correspondence with each hardware ID and drawing number.
PAGE
Pressing the PAGE key PAGE
displays the system configuration
screen of other PCBs.
26
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
1.4
ALARM HISTORY
SCREEN
1.4.1 Alarms generated in the NC are recorded. The latest 25 alarms generated
General are recorded. The 26th and former alarms are deleted.
1.4.2
Screen Display (1) Press MESSAGE
key .
(2) Press soft key [HISTRY] and an alarm history screen is displayed.
PAGE
(3) Other pages are displayed by PAGE
or key.
97/04/18 20:56:26
506 OVERTRAVEL : +X
97/04/18 19:58:11
000 TURN OFF POWER
97/04/18 19:52:45
000 TURN OFF POWER
97/04/18 19:48:43
300 APC ALARM : X–AXIS ZERO RETURN REQUEST
97/04/18 18:10:10
507 OVERTRAVEL : +B
1.4.4 When an external alarm (No. 1000 to 1999) or a macro alarm (No. 3000
Alarm Display to 3999) is output, the alarm history function can record both the alarm
number and message if so specified in the following parameter. If
recording of the message is not set or if no message is input, only an
external alarm or macro alarm is displayed.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3112 EAH
27
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
1.5
This function enables the saving of external operator messages as a
EXTERNAL record.
OPERATOR The record can be viewed on the external operator message history screen.
MESSAGES
RECORD
1.5.2
Deletion of External (1) The recorded external operator message can be deleted by setting the
Operator Messages MMC bit (bit 0 of parameter 3113) to 1.
Pressing the [CLEAR] soft key erases all the records of the external
Record
operator message.
(2) The MS1 and MS0 bits (bits 7 and 6 of parameter 3113) specify the
number of records to be displayed on the external operator message
history screen. When the bits are changed, all external operator
message records retained up to that point are erased.
28
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
1.5.3
Parameter
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3113 MS1 MS0 MHC
0 0 255 8
0 1 200 10
1 0 100 18
1 1 50 32
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3112 OMH
NOTE
After setting this parameter, briefly turn the power off, then
on again.
1.5.4 When the number of an external operator message is specified, the system
Notes starts updating the records of the specified message. The system
continues to perform update until another external operator message is
specified or until an instruction to delete the records of the external
operator message is specified.
29
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
1.6 This function displays the key and signal operations performed by the
operator upon the occurrence of a fault or the output of an alarm, together
OPERATION HISTORY with the corresponding alarms.
This function records the following data:
(1) MDI key operations performed by the operator
(2) Status changes (ON/OFF) of input and output signals (selected signals
only)
(3) Details of alarms
(4) Time stamp (date and time)
1.6.1
Parameter Setting
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3106 OHS OPH
3122 Interval at which the clock time is recorded in the operation history
30
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
1.6.2
Screen Display
D Displaying the operation
(1) Press the SYSTEM
function key.
history
(2) Press the continue menu key [ ]. The [OPEHIS] [(OPRT)] soft key
are displayed.
(3) Press the [OPEHIS] soft key twice. The operation history screen is
displayed.
On the operation history screen, the soft keys are configured as shown
below:
⇒[ ] [ PARAM ] [DGNOS] [PMC]
[SYSTEM] [(OPE)] [ ]
ãpush
[ ] [W.DGNS] [ ] [ ] [OPEHIS] [(OPE)] [ ]
ã push
[ ] [ OPEHIS ] [SG–SEL] [ ] [ ] [(OPE)] [ ]
ãpush
[ ] [ TOP ] [BOTTOM] [ ] [ ] [PG.SRH] [ ]
(4) To display the next part of the operation history, press the page down
PAGE
31
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
32
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
Input signal
Name displayed
MD1 ND2 MD4 REF DNC1
0 0 0 0 0 MDI
1 0 0 0 0 MEM
1 0 0 0 1 RMT
0 1 0 0 0 NOMODE
1 1 0 0 0 EDT
0 0 1 0 0 H/INC
1 0 1 0 0 JOG
1 0 1 1 0 REF
0 1 1 0 0 TJOG
1 1 1 0 0 THND
Input signal
Name displayed
ROV1 ROV2
0 0 R 100%
1 0 R 50%
0 1 R 25%
1 1 R F0%
(3) NC alarms
NC alarms are displayed in reverse video.
P/S alarms, system alarms, and external alarms are displayed together
with their numbers.
For other types of alarms, only the alarm type is displayed. (No details
are displayed.)
For two–path control, the operations of path 2 are displayed in the
same way, but preceded by S_.
Example) P/S0050, SV_ALM, S_APC_ALM
33
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
NOTE
The clock time is recorded for a specified interval only when
data is stored within that interval.
signal to be recorded in
the operation history (2) Press the continuous menu key [ ]. The [OPEHIS] (operation
history) soft key is displayed.
(3) Press the [OPEHIS] soft key, then press the [SG–SEL] soft key. The
operation history signal selection screen is displayed.
34
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
1.6.3
Setting The Input (1) On the operation history signal selection screen, press the [(OPE)] soft
Signal or Output Signal key.
to Be Recorded in The OP_HIS SIGNAL SELECT O1000 N02000
Operation History
No. ADDRES SIGNAL No. ADDRES SIGNAL
01 G0004 00000010 11 ********
02 ******** 12 ********
03 ******** 13 ********
04 ******** 14 ********
05 ******** 15 ********
06 ******** 16 ********
07 ******** 17 ********
08 ******** 18 ********
09 ******** 19 ********
10 ******** 20 ********
>
EDIT **** *** *** *** 00:00:00
[ ALLDEL ][ DELETE ][ ON:1 ][ OFF:0 ][ ]
key.
Example) G0004 INPUT
35
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
(8) Pressing the return menu key [ ] causes the [OPEHIS] (OPE) soft
key to be displayed again.
D Input signals and output
signals to be recorded in
the history NOTE
1 A cross (×) indicates that a signal will not be recorded. Also,
any signal for which an address is not specified will not be
recorded, either.
2 A circle (f) indicates that a signal can be recorded.
3 A signal indicated by its symbol name will also be displayed
by its symbol name.
1. M/T addresses
MT→PMC
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
X000 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
X127 f f f f f f f f
PMC→CNC
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
G000 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G003 f f f f f f f f
G004 f f f f FIN f f f
G009 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G013 f f f f f f f f
G014 f f f f f f f f
G015 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G018 f f f f f f f f
G019 RT f f f f f f f
36
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
G020 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G042 f f f f f f f f
G043 f × f × × f f f
G047 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G060 f f f f f f f f
G061 f f f f f f f RGTA
G062 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G099 f f f f f f f f
G101 f f f f f f f f
G103 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G105 f f f f f f f f
G107 f f f f f f f f
G109 f f f f f f f f
G111 f f f f f f f f
G113 f f f f f f f f
37
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
G115 f f f f f f f f
G117 f f f f f f f f
G119 f f f f f f f f
G121 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G125 f f f f f f f f
G127 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G129 f f f f f f f f
G131 f f f f f f f f
G133 f f f f f f f f
G135 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G255 f f f f f f f f
PMC→MT
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
Y000 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
Y127 f f f f f f f f
CNC→PMC
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
F000 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
F255 f f f f f f f f
38
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
∼∼
X127 f f f f f f f f
G003 f f f f f f f f
G004 f f f f FIN f f f
G009 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G013 f f f f f f f f
G014 f f f f f f f f
G015 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G018 f f f f f f f f
G019 RT f f f f f f f
G020 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G042 f f f f f f f f
G043 f × f × × f f f
G047 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G060 f f f f f f f f
39
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
G061 f f f f f f f RGTA
G062 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G099 f f f f f f f f
G101 f f f f f f f f
G103 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G105 f f f f f f f f
G107 f f f f f f f f
G109 f f f f f f f f
G111 f f f f f f f f
G113 f f f f f f f f
G115 f f f f f f f f
G117 f f f f f f f f
G119 f f f f f f f f
G121 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G125 f f f f f f f f
40
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
G126 SVF8 SVF7 SVF6 SVF5 SVF4 SVF3 SVF2 SVF1
G127 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G129 f f f f f f f f
G131 f f f f f f f f
G133 f f f f f f f f
G135 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G255 f f f f f f f f
G1003 f f f f f f f f
G1004 f f f f FIN f f f
G1009 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G1013 f f f f f f f f
G1014 f f f f f f f f
G1015 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G1018 f f f f f f f f
G1019 RT f f f f f f f
41
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
G1020 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G1042 f f f f f f f f
G1043 f × f × × f f f
G1047 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G1060 f f f f f f f f
G1061 f f f f f f f RGTA
G1062 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G1099 f f f f f f f f
G1101 f f f f f f f f
G1103 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G1105 f f f f f f f f
G1107 f f f f f f f f
G1109 f f f f f f f f
G1111 f f f f f f f f
G1113 f f f f f f f f
G1115 f f f f f f f f
42
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
G1116 *–L8 *–L7 *–L6 *–L5 *–L4 *–L3 *–L2 *–L1
G1117 f f f f f f f f
G1119 f f f f f f f f
G1121 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G1125 f f f f f f f f
G1127 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G1129 f f f f f f f f
G1131 f f f f f f f f
G1133 f f f f f f f f
G1135 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
G1255 f f f f f f f f
PMC→MT
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
Y000 f f f f f f f f
∼∼
Y127 f f f f f f f f
F255 f f f f f f f f
F1255 f f f f f f f f
43
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
(2) Press the SYSTEM key, then select the operation history display screen.
(3) Press the soft keys [(OPRT)], , [PUNCH], and [EXEC] in this
order.
The data output to the FANUC Floppy Cassette or FANUC FA Card is
stored under file name OPERATION HISTORY.
(2) Press the SYSTEM key, then select the operation history display screen.
(3) Press the soft keys [(OPRT)], , [READ], and [EXEC] in this
order.
D Output data format 1. MDI/soft key
2. Signal
3. Alarm
4. For extension (date or time)
5. MDI/soft key of path 2
6. Signal of path 2
7. Alarm of path 2
The header and recorded operation data are output, in this order. The
operation history data is divided into four parts by identifier words. Data
other than the identifier words depends on the type.
T(identifier word)
T0 : Header
T50 : MDI/soft key
T51 : Signal
T52 : Alarm
T53 : For extension (date or time)
T54 : MDI/soft key of path 2
T55 : Signal of path 2
T56 : Alarm of path 2
44
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
1) Header
T 0 C O P E R A T I O N
H I S T O R Y ;
C: Data word
2) MDI/soft key
T 5 0 P 0 to 1 H * * ;
P0: Usually
P1: At power–on
H **: Key code (See the following table.)
3) Signal
T 5 1 P 0 to 6 N 0 to 255 H * * , * * ;
45
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
4) Alarm
T 5 2 P 0 to 10 N * * * * ;
Date T 5 3 P 0 to 1 E 0 D * * * * * * * * ;
Time T 5 3 P 0 to 1 E 1 D * * * * * * ;
P0: Usually
P1: At power–on
E0: Date
E1: Time
D*..*: Data Example) October 29, 1997
D 1 9 9 7 1 0 2 9
46
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
T 5 4 P 0 to 1 H * * ;
P0: Usually
P1: At power–on
H **: KCB code (See the following table.)
7) Signal of path 2
T 5 5 P 2, 6 N 1000 to 1255 H * * , * * ;
8) Alarm of path 2
T 5 6 P 0 to 10 N * * * * ;
47
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
0 Space 0 @ P
1 ! 1 A Q
2 ” 2 B R
3 # 3 C S
4 $ 4 D T
5 % 5 E U
6 & 6 F V
7 ’ 7 G W
8 ( 8 H X
9 ) 9 I Y
A ; * : J Z
(EOB)
B + K [
C ’ < L ¥
D – = M ]
E . > N
F / ? O –
48
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
(80H to FFH)
8 9 A B C D E F
0 Reset F0
* *
1 MMC F1
* *
2 CNC F2
* *
3 F3
*
4 Shift Insert F4
* *
5 Delete F5
* *
6 CAN Alter F6
* *
7 F7
*
9 Cur← PROG F9
* * *
B Cur↑ SYSTEM
* *
C MESSAGE
*
D CUSTOM
GRAPH
*1*
E Page↓ CUSTOM FR
* * *
F Page↑ Fapt FL
* * *
CUSTOM
key.
* : Command key
49
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
1.6.5
Notes (1) While the operation history screen is displayed, no information can be
recorded to the history.
(2) An input signal having an on/off width of up to 16 msec is not recorded
in the history. Some signals are not recorded in the history. See
Appendix 1.
(3) Once the storage becomes full, old data is deleted, starting from the
oldest record. Up to about 8000 key information items can be
recorded.
(4) The recorded data is retained even after the power is turned off. A
memory all clear operation, however, erases the recorded data.
(5) The operation history function cannot execute sampling when the
OHS bit (bit 7 of parameter No. 3106) is set to 1.
(6) Set the date and time on the setting screen.
(7) The time needed to input and output 6000 operation records at a rate
of 4800 baud is as follows:
Output:About 5 minutes
Input: About 2 minutes and 30 seconds
This file corresponds to a paper tape of about 180 m in length.
50
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
1.7
HELP FUNCTION
1.7.1
General The help function displays alarm information, operation method and a
table of contents for parameters. This function is used as a handbook.
1.7.2 Press HELP key on any screen other than PMC screen, then a help screen
Display Method
appears.
(However, it is not available when PMC screen/CUSTOM screen is
displaying)
D Display of help screen
D Help for alarm (1) When an alarm is generated, press soft key [ALARM], then a help
message of the alarm is displayed.
NUMBER : 010
M’SAGE : IMPROPER G CODE
FUNCTION :
ALARM :
A G CODE NOT LISTED IN G–CODE TABLE
IS BEING COMMANDED
ALSO G–CODE FOR FUNCTION NOT ADDED
IS BEING COMMANDED
(2) Pressing soft key [OPERAT],(alarm No.), and soft key [SELECT]
in this order, a help message corresponding to the input alarm number
is displayed.
51
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
D Help for operation (1) Press [2 OPR], then a menu for operation method is displayed.
1. PROGRAM EDIT
2. SEARCH
3. RESET
4. DATA INPUT WITH MDI
5. DATA INPUT WITH TAPE
6. OUTPUT
7. INPUT WITH FANUC CASSETTE
8. OUTPUT WITH FANUC CASSETTE
9. MEMORY CLEAR
(2) Press [OPERAT], (an item number) and soft key [SELECT], then an
operation method of the item is displayed.
PAGE
Pressing PAGE key PAGE
or displays another pages.
[ ] [ ] [ ] [ ] [SELECT]
52
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
D Parameter table Press soft key [3 PARA], then a parameter table is displayed.
PAGE
Another screen can be selected by the PAGE key PAGE
or .
53
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
1.8
DISPLAYING
DIAGNOSTIC PAGE
1.8.2
Contents Displayed
D Causes when the
machine does not travel 000 WAITING FOR FIN SIGNAL An auxiliary function is being
in spite of giving a executed.
command 001 MOTION Travel command of cycle
operation is being executed.
002 DWELL DWELL Dwell is being
executed.
003 IN–POSITION CHECK In–position check is being done.
004 FEEDRATE OVERRIDE 0% Feedrate override is 0%.
005 INTERLOCK/START LOCK Interlock or start lock is input.
006 SPINDLE SPEED ARRIVAL CHECK Waiting for spindle speed
arrival signal.
010 PUNCHING Data is being output through
reader/puncher interface.
011 READING Data is being input through
reader/puncher interface.
012 WAITING FOR (UN) CLAMP Waiting for the end of index
table indexing
013 JOG FEEDRATE OVERRIDE 0% Manual feedrate override is 0%.
014 WAITING FOR RESET, ESP,RRW OFF NC is in reset state.
015 EXTERNAL PROGRAM NUMBER SEARCH External Program Number
Search External program
number search is being done
016 BACKGROUND ACTIVE Background is being used.
54
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
D State of TH alarm
030 CHARACTER NUMBER TH ALARM Position of the character that
caused TH alarm. The position
is counted from the head.
031 TH DATA Data of the character that caused
TH alarm.
D Detail of serial pulse
coder
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
DGN 0202 CSA BLA PHA RCA BZA CKA SPH
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
DGN 0203 DTE CRC STB
55
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
DGN 0204 RAM OFS MCC LDA PMS
#0 (MOT): The motor type specified in parameter No. 2020 falls outside the
predetermined range.
#2 (PLC): The number of velocity feedback pulses per motor revolution, specified in
parameter No. 2023, is zero or less. The value is invalid.
#3 (PLS): The number of position feedback pulses per motor revolution, specified in
parameter No. 2024, is zero or less. The value is invalid.
#4 (DIR): The wrong direction of rotation for the motor is specified in parameter No.
2022 (the value is other than 111 or –111).
#6 (AXS): In parameter No. 1023 (servo axis number), a value that falls outside the
range of 1 to the number of controlled axes is specified. (For example, 4 is
specified instead of 3.) Alternatively, the values specified in the
parameter are not consecutive.
56
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
D Machine position
#0(PR1): The setting of the following parameters has been changed: Parameters
1821, 1850, 1860, 1861.
#1(PR2): The setting of the ATS bit (bit 1 of parameter 8302) has been changed.
#2(BZ1): The detected APC battery voltage is 0 V (Inductosyn).
#3(BZ2): The detected APC battery voltage is 0 V (separate position detector).
#4(NOF): The Inductosyn output no offset data.
#5(ALP): Before the α pulse coder detects a full single rotation, reference position
establishment by parameters was attempted.
#6(DTH): A controlled axis detach signal/parameter was input.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
DGN 311 DUA XBZ GSG AL4 AL3 AL2 AL1
57
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
DGN 380 Difference between the absolute position of the motor and offset data
Off set data is displayed when CNC calculates the machine position.
[Data type] Two–word axis
[Units of data] Detection units
D Serial spindle
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
DGN 0400 SAI SS2 SSR POS SIC
This data indicates the offset data received by the CNC while it is
calculating the machine coordinates.
#4(SAI) 0 : Spindle analog control is not used.
1 : Spindle analog control is used.
#3(SS2) 0 : Spindle serial doesn’t control 2nd spindle.
1 : Spindle serial control 2nd spindle.
#2(SSR) 0 : Spindle serial control is not performed.
1 : Spindle serial control is performed.
#1 (POS) A module required for spindle analog control is
0 : not mounted
1 : mounted
#0 (SIC) A module required for spindle serial control is
0 : not mounted
1 : mounted
58
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
DGN 0408 SSA SCA CME CER SNE FRE CRE
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
DGN 0409 SPE S2E S1E SHE
DGN 0416 Absolute value of synchronization error between 1st and 2nd spindles
59
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
DGN 455 Instantaneous difference for the move command, calculated in terms of the spindle,
during rigid tapping (signed, accumulated value)
DGN 456 Instantaneous difference for the travel error, calculated in terms of the spindle,
during rigid tapping (signed)
DGN 457 Width of synchronization error during rigid tapping (maximum value)
60
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
D Two–spindle polygon This data indicates the status of the polygon synchronization mode.
machining
(T series only)
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
470 SC0 LGE SCF PST SPL
CAUTION
D If SPL and SCF are set to 1 and #1, #2, and #3 are set to 0 in polygon synchronization mode,
the operation is normal.
Notes
1 If the status does not change, even though PST is set to 1 and the program is stopped in a block
including G51.2, one of the spindles cannot attain the polygon synchronization speed. This
may occur when the spindle cannot be activated because the PSTU bit (bit 7 of parameter No.
7603) is set to 0.
2 LGE is set to 1 when the speed is changed in polygon synchronization mode if the serial spindle
control unit uses different loop gains for the first and second spindles during spindle
synchronization.
When this function is used, the two spindles must be controlled with an identical loop gain. The
warning is displayed in DGN, but the warning does not cause an alarm. (The serial spindle
control unit switches parameters according to the statuses of CTH1, CTH2, and other signals.)
3 SCO is set to 1 if either of the following occurs: The combination of the programmed S value
and spindle control signals including *SSTP <G0029, #6>, SOV0 to SOV7 <G0030> and
multispindle control signal <G0027> causes 0 or a value smaller than the resolution of spindle
control to be programmed (the programmed value multiplied by 4095/highest–spindle–speed
is smaller than 1).
Alternatively, SIND control <G0032, G0033> is used and the programmed output is 0.
When SCO is set to 1, the spindle speed becomes 0, setting bit 0 of DGN 471 to 1 and disabling
the ratio of polygon synchronization rotation. This, however, is handled as a result of the
program, and does not cause P/S alarm No. 5018.
61
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
471 NPQ PQE NSP SUO QCL PCL
CAUTION
Bit 0 is set to 1 even when the specified spindle speed is 0 (bit 7 of DGN 470 is set to 1). This,
however, does not cause P/S alarm No. 5018 to be output (because the programmed speed
is 0). P/S alarm No. 5018 occurs when bit 7 of DGN 470 is set to 0, while bit 0 of DGN 471 is
set to 1. Normal spindle speeds will not cause this alarm to be output.
NOTE
1 PCL indicates that the speed specified for the master axis exceeds the maximum speed for the
first axis, specified in parameters No. 3741 to 3744, causing, the specified speed to be limited
to the maximum speed.
PCL is not set to 1 provided the first spindle is connected correctly.
2 QCL is set to 1 when the polygon synchronization speed specified for the second spindle (slave
axis in polygon synchronization) exceeds the value set in parameter No. 7621, causing the
actual speed to be limited to the specified value.
3 SUO occurs if the number of distributed pulses for ITP exceeds 32767, that is, if the speed
specified for the first axis, divided by the specified P value, exceeds 59998. In other words,
SUO occurs when a speed in excess of 59998 rpm is specified for the first axis if P is set to 1.
62
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
DGN 474 Rotation ratio of the master axis in spindle polygon synchronization
(specified P value)
DGN 475 Rotation ratio of the slave axis in spindle polygon synchronization
(specified Q value)
DGN 476 Phase difference between two spindles in spindle polygon synchronization
(specified R value)
If the RDGN bit (bit 5 of parameter 7603) is set to 1, the shift amount
specified for the serial spindle (number of specified pulses, calculated at
a rate of 4096 pulses per 360 degrees) is displayed.
DGN 477 Actual speed of the master axis for spindle polygon synchronization (rpm)
DGN 478 Actual speed of the slave axis in spindle polygon synchronization (rpm)
NOTE
The values of DGN 477 and DGN 478 are displayed without being sampled. The displayed
values may vary from the actual values. Use these values for guidance only.
63
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
0: Not ready
1: Reset state
2: Operation state
3: Alarm state
4: Circuit disconnection
D Open CNC
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
DGN 510
This data indicates the internal Open CNC information (not available to
general users).
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
DGN 511
This data indicates the internal Open CNC information (not available to
general users).
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
DGN 512 PA1 PA0 BNK THH THL PRA
This data indicates the cause of a system alarm that has occurred in Open
CNC.
#0(PRA) 1 : A RAM parity error occurred in shared RAM.
#2(THL) 0 : The temperature of the harddisk of Open CNC is too low.
1 : Normal
#3(THH) 0 : The temperature of the harddisk of Open CNC is too high.
1 : Normal
#4 0 : Normal
1 : An NMI has occurred in HSSB.
#5(BNK) If bit 0 (PRA) is set to 1,
0 : An alarm occurred in the lower half of shared RAM.
1 : An alarm occurred in the upper half of shared RAM.
#6 (PA0) If bit 0 (PRA) is set to 1,
1 : An alarm occurred at an even–numbered address.
#7 (PA1) If bit 0 (PRA) is set to 1,
1 : An alarm occurred at an odd–numbered address.
64
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
DGN 520 Total number of retractions during cutting after G83 is specified
DGN 521 Total number of retractions made by receiving the overload signal during cutting
after G83 is specified
DGN 522 Position on the drill axis from which retraction is started
DGN 523 Difference between the position on the drill axis from which the previous retraction
was started and the position from which the current retraction is started
65
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
DGN 530 A99 A98 A97 A96 A95 A43
#6 (585): Spindle servo alarm (excessive error during ATC magazine indexing)
#5 (584): Invalid sequence during positioning and ATC (system error)
#4 (583): Spindle servo alarm (LSI overflow)
#3 (582): Spindle servo alarm (excessive drift)
#2 (581): Spindle servo alarm (excessive error during travel)
#1 (580): Spindle servo alarm (excessive error in the stop state)
#0 (502): Large spindle distribution (system error)
DGN 540 Difference in the position error between the master and slave axes in simple synchro-
nas control
DGN 541 Difference in the position error between the master and slave axes in simple synchro-
nas control
D Diagnostic data related DGN 540 indicates the difference in the position error between the master
to simple synchronous and slave axes when a single axis pair is subjected to simple synchronous
control control. DGN 541 is used when two or more pairs are subjected to simple
synchronous control. The position error is indicated for the master axis.
DGN 540 and 541 indicate values in detection units. They are displayed
only with the M series.
66
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
67
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
The data items displayed on the diagnosis screen are obtained at the
following positions:
Semi–closed loop
error (No. 551)
Motor
Command
+ + +
Kp Speed Machine
- + control
-
Servo amplifier
Ps
Conversion
coefficients
68
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
1.9
CNC STATE DISPLAY ACTUAL POSITION (ABSOLUTE) O1000 N00010
X 217.940
Y 363.233
Z 0.000
PART COUNT 5
RUN TIME 0H15M CYCLE TIME 0H 0M38S
ACT.F 3000MM/M S 0 T0000
– –EMG– –/–RESET–
(Emergency stop/reset state)
STRT/STOP/HOLD/INC
(Start/Stop/Hold state)
Mode display
EDIT/MEM/RMT/MDI/INC
HND/JOG/REF/THND/TJOG
EDIT: Edit mode
MEM: Memory mode
RMT: Remote operation mode
MDI: MDI operation mode
INC: Incremental feed mode
(Without manual pulse
generator)
HND: Handle feed mode
JOG: Jog feed mode
REF: Reference position
return mode
THND: TEACH IN NANDLE
mode
TJOG: TEACH IN JOG mode
69
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
1.10 Tuning becomes easier by graphically displaying servo error amount and
torque command, etc. (Graphic option is required).
WAVE FORM
DIAGNOSTIC The following two types of waveform diagnosis functions are supported:
FUNCTION (1) One–shot type
The one–shot type waveform diagnosis function can graphically
display, as a waveform, any variation in those data items listed below.
The start of data sampling can be triggered by the rising or falling edge
of a machine signal. This function facilitates the adjustment of the
servo and spindle motors.
a. Error, pulse distribution amount, torque, speed, current, and
thermal simulation data for the servo motor of each axis
b. Composite speed for the first, second, and third axes
c. Spindle motor speed and load meter value
d. On/off state of a machine signal specified with a signal address
(2) Storage type
The storage type waveform diagnosis function enables the storing
of any variation in the data items listed below and, if a servo alarm
occurs, the graphical display (as a waveform) of the stored data. The
end of data sampling can be triggered by the rising or falling edge
of a machine signal. This function facilitates the estimation of
erroneous locations. Stored data can be output via the reader/punch
interface.
a. Error, pulse distribution amount, torque, speed, current, and
thermal simulation data for the servo motor for each axis
NOTE
1 To output stored waveform data, the optional reader/punch
interface must have been installed.
2 The waveform diagnosis function is enabled when bit 0
(SGD) of parameter No. 3112 is set to 1. Note, however, that
a graphics card is necessary to display waveforms.
1.10.1 (1) Set a parameter to utilize the servo waveform diagnostic function.
Setting Parameters
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3112 SGD
70
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
1.10.2 1.Press the SYSTEM key to display a system screen such as aparameter.
Waveform Diagnostic
Parameter Screen 2. Press the continuous menu key several times, and the soft key
[W.DGNS] is displayed.
3. Press [W.DGNS], then the parameter screen for the waveform
diagnosis is displayed.
Set the necessary data items. Position the cursor to the item to be set,
enter the corresponding data, then press INPUT . Data items for which
***** is displayed cannot be set. To assist in data setting, the frame on
the right side of the screen displays help information for that data to which
the cursor is positioned. Help information which cannot fit into a single
frame is split into several pages, which the user can scroll through using
the page keys and .
71
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
(4) Data number: The table below lists the numbers of the data items for
which a waveform can be displayed (n = 1 to 8).
Data No. Description Units
0n Servo error (8 ms) for the n–th axis (positional devi- Pulses
ation) (detection units)
3n Servo error (2 ms) for the n–th axis (positional devi- Pulses
ation) (detection units)
7n Thermal simulation data for the n–th axis % (OVC alarm ratio)
90 Composite speed for the first, second, and third axes Pulses
(input increments)
10n Actual spindle speed for the n–th axis % (relative to maxi-
mum rotation
speed)
11n Load meter for the spindle for the n–th axis % (relative to maxi-
mum output)
(5) Data units: Weight of data when 1 is specified. The data units are
automatically specified for each data item and need not be set unless
the units must be changed for some reason.
[Valid data range] 1 to 1000
[Unit] 0.001
(6) Signal address: PMC address and bit number. Set in the same way as
that for trigger, when the data number is 99.
72
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
0n Servo error (8 ms) for the n–th axis (positional devi- Pulses
ation) (detection units)
7n Thermal simulation data for the n–th axis % (OVC alarm ratio)
(5) Data units: Weight of data when 1 is specified. The data units are
automatically specified for each data item and need not be set unless
the units must be changed for some reason.
[Valid data range] 1 to 1000
[Unit] 0.001
73
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
CH1 CH2
1.0 1.0
0.5 0.5
0 0
–0. –0.
5 5
–1. –1.
0 0
[START] [TIME³] [²TIME] [H–DOBL] [H–HALF]
2. Press soft key [(OPRT)], then the following soft keys are displayed.
The following three sets of soft keys are displayed by the key.
D Drawing a waveform for The one–shot type waveform diagnosis function draws a waveform for a
one–shot type waveform specified data item in real time as the data is sampled. The sampled data,
diagnosis however, is not stored and thus cannot be output later.
74
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
Pressing the [SATART] soft key starts data sampling. While sampling
is being performed, SAMPLING blinks at the top of the screen. Once data
sampling has been completed, a waveform is automatically displayed.
CH1 CH2
D Drawing a waveform for To use storage type waveform diagnosis, set 100 for the display start
storage type waveform condition. The maximum data width for storage type waveform diagnosis
diagnosis is 32760 ms. Data must be sampled before starting drawing. The next
page explains sampling in detail.
Pressing the [START] soft key loads stored data. While the data is being
loaded, SAMPLING blinks at the top of the screen. Once the data has
been loaded, a waveform is displayed. The date on which the data was
stored is displayed at the top left of the screen. If the [START] soft key
is pressed while data is being stored, storage is stopped and the waveform
for the data stored up to that point is displayed. The WAVE DIAGNOS.
(MEMORY) screen indicates whether data is being stored.
75
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
1.10.4 (1) Press the SYSTEM function key. Pressing the menu continuation key [ ]
Data Sampling for displays the [W.DGNS] soft key. Press this soft key to display the
Storage Type WAVE DIAGNOS. (PARAMETER) screen.
Waveform Diagnosis
(2) Press the [W.MEM] soft key to display the WAVE DIAGNOS.
(MEMORY) screen. The operation selection soft keys appear.
The configuration of the operation selection soft keys is as follows:
Press
[SELECT] [ ] [ ] [ ] [START]
[ ] [ ] [PUNCH] [ ] [ ]
(4) Using the cursor, set the necessary data items. To set the sampling
axes, position the cursor to the data item to be set, enter the names of
the axes for which data will be sampled for that data item, then press
[SELECT] or INPUT . The axis names are displayed to the right of the
data items.
Once the sampling axes have been selected, the sampling period for each
axis is displayed. Subsequently pressing the [START] soft key starts data
sampling.
76
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
CAUTION
1 Data items for which ***** is displayed cannot be set.
2 To change the sampling axes, enter new axis names then
press the [SELECT] soft key. Pressing the [SLELCT] soft
key without entering an axis name results in no sampling
axis being set.
3 If the sampling axes are changed during data sampling,
data sampling is stopped. In this case, press the [START]
soft key to restart data sampling for the new sampling axes.
4 Initially, no sampling axis is set.
POS ERROR Servo error (8 ms) for the n–th axis Pulses
(detection units)
TORQUE CMD Command current for the n–th axis % (relative to maxi-
mum current)
(4) Sampling axis: The axes along which data will be sampled are
displayed.
(5) Sampling period: The sampling period for each axis is displayed.
(6) Date of storage: While data is being sampled, MEMORY blinks in this
field. When data sampling stops, the date at that point appears in this
field.
77
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
1.10.5 Waveform diagnosis data of servo alarm format can be output to an I/O
Outputting Waveform device, as follows:
Diagnosis Data 1) Select EDIT mode.
(Storage Type) 2) Press the SYSTEM key, then display the WAVE DIAGNOS. (MEMORY)
screen.
3) Press the [W.MEM], , [PUNCH], and [EXEC] soft keys, in this
order.
For details of input/output to/from the FANUC Floppy Cassette or FA
Card, see “Output to FANUC Floppy Cassette or FA Card,” below.
[ ] [ ] [PUNCH] [ ] [ ]
Press
[ ] [ ] [ ] [ CAN ] [ EXEC ]
Press
78
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
D Directory display The directory in the cassette or card is displayed by means of the
following procedure:
1) Select EDIT mode.
D Deleting a file A file stored on a cassette or card is deleted by means of the following
procedure:
1) Select EDIT mode.
3) Set the write protect switch on the cassette or card to enable writing.
4) Press [FLOPPY].
5) Press [DELETE].
6) Enter the file number, then press [F SET].
7) Press [EXEC].
The file corresponding to the specified file number is deleted. The
number of each file subsequent to the deleted file is decremented by
one.
79
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
D Output format In the servo alarm format, the header, date and time, selected axes, and
waveform diagnosis data are output in this order. Data items are identified
by nine identifier words. Output data other than the identifier words
varies with the data type.
T(identifier word)
T0 : Header
T60 : Positional deviation
T61 : Move command
T62 : Actual current
T63 : Actual speed
T64 : Command current
T65 : Thermal simulation
T68 : Selected axes
T69 : Date and time
1) Header
T 0 C W A V E D I A G N O S ;
C: Data word
2) Data word
T 6 9 D * * * * * * , * * * * * * ;
T 6 9 D 1 9 9 2 0 6 2 3 , 1 2 1 4 5 9 ;
3) Selected axes
T 6 8 P * * D * * , * * , X * * ,
80
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
T 6 0 D * * , * * , * * , X * * ,
T 6 1 D * * , * * , * * , X * * ,
T 6 2 D * * , * * , * * , X * * ,
T 6 3 D * * , * * , * * , X * * ,
T 6 4 D * * , * * , * * , X * * ,
T 6 5 D * * , * * , * * , X * * ,
NOTE
1 Records are classified into header records and data
records.
2 ”%” is used as an end–of–record code.
3 Each record starts with an identifier and ends with an
end–of–block code.
4 Either the ISO or EIA code system is used.
5 The output code type is specified with parameter ISO (bit 1
of No. 0100). For ISO code, parameter NCR (bit 3 of No.
0100) is used to specify whether the end–of–block code is
<LF> only, or a sequence of <LF> <CR> <CR>.
6 Parameter NFD (bit 7 of No. 01X1, where X is the channel
number) is used to specify whether a feed code is output
before and after the data.
7 No identifier word is output for a data item for which no axis
is selected.
8 The above file corresponds to a paper tape of about 200 m
in length.
1.10.6
Notes (1) Once the storage is full, the oldest data is overwritten.
(2) Stored–type waveform diagnostic data is not lost, even when the
power is turned off.
(3) The waveform diagnostic function is disabled when parameter SGD
(bit 0 of No. 3112) is set to 0.
(4) Set the correct date and time using the setting screen.
81
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
1.11 Load meter of the servo axis and the serial spindle and the speed meter
can be displayed.
OPERATING
MONITOR
Z : * * * * * 0% S1: * * * 1500
PART COUNT 5
RUN TIME 0H15M CYCLE TIME 0H 0M38S
ACT.F 3000 MM/M S 0 T 0000
NOTE
1 The bar graph for the load meter shows load up to 200%.
2 The bar graph for the speed meter shows the ratio of the
current spindle speed to the maximum spindle speed
(100%). Although the speed meter normally indicates the
speed of the spindle motor, it can also be used to indicate
the speed of the spindle by setting bit 6. (OPS) of parameter
3111 to 1.
3 The servo axes for their load meters are displayed are set
to parameter No. 3151 to 3. If parameters 3151 to 3153 are
all zero, the load meter of the basic axes are displayed.
4 For color display, the bar of the load meter that exceed
100% shows purple color.
82
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
1.11.2
Parameters
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
311 OPS OPM
3151 Axis number for which the first servo motor load meter is displayed
3152 Axis number for which the second servo motor load meter is displayed
3153 Axis number for which the third servo motor load meter is displayed
3154 Axis number for which the fourth servo motor load meter is displayed
3155 Axis number for which the fifth servo motor load meter is displayed
3156 Axis number for which the sixth servo motor load meter is displayed
3157 Axis number for which the seventh servo motor load meter is displayed
3158 Axis number for which the eighth servo motor load meter is displayed
83
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
1.12
LIST OF OPERATIONS
Reset
Data
Param- Func-
protec-
Function eter Mode tion Operation
tion
write=1 button
key
Resetting run hour [(OPRT)] [RUNPRE]→[EXEC]
– POS
SYSTEM
Parameter no.→[NO.SRH]→Data→ INPUT
Inputting MDI or
Yes
parameters E.Stop (PA- → PWE =0 → RESET
RAM)
Inputting offset
OFF – OFFSET
SETTING Offset number→[NO.SRH]→Offset value→ INPUT
values
Inputting setting
OFF MDI OFFSET
SETTING Setting no.→[NO.SRH]Data→ INPUT
data
Input of PMC
parameters, counter OFF [PMCPRM]→[COUNTR] or [DATA]→Data→ INPUT
and data table MDI or
SYSTEM
OFFSET
SETTING
Offset no.→[NO.SRH]→<AXIS>→[INP.C]
84
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
→[ " ]→[READ]→[EXEC]
85
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
parameter
EDIT NAME) [FDCAS] →(KIND OF DATA) [PARAM] → [WRITE]
(PMC)
→ (FILE NO) * 1 INPUT →[EXEC]
Output of all
EDIT PROG O →–9999→[ " ]→[PUNCH]→[EXEC]
programs
Output of one
EDIT PROG O →Program no.→[ " ]→[PUNCH]→[EXEC]
program
Search
Data
Param- Func-
protec-
Function eter Mode tion Operation
tion
write=1 button
key
Searching a MEMO
program number RY PROG O →Program no.→[O SRH]
or EDIT
Searching a MEMO
sequence number PROG Program no. search→ N →Sequence number→[NSRH]
RY
Searching an
address word Data to be searched→[SRH↑] or[SRH↓] or
EDIT PROG
(cursor key)
Searching an
Address to be searched [SRH↑] or[SRH↓] or
address only EDIT PROG
(Cursor key)
Searching an offset Offset no.→[NO.SRH]
number – OFFSET
SETTING
86
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
Edit
Data
Param- Func-
protec-
Function eter Mode tion Operation
tion
write=1 button
key
Display of memory [LIB]
EDIT PROG
capacity used
OFF
Deleting a program EDIT PROG O →Program no.→ DELETE
OFF
Deleting a word EDIT PROG Searching a word to be deleted→ DELETE
OFF
Changing a word EDIT PROG Searching a word to be changed→New Data→ ALTER
Collation
Data
Param- Func-
protec-
Function eter Mode tion Operation
tion
write=1 button
key
ON [(OPRT)]→[ " ]→[READ]→[EXEC]
Collating memory EDIT PROG
Playback
Data
Param- Func-
protec-
Function eter Mode tion Operation
tion
write=1 button
key
TEACH
–IN Jog the machine→ X , Y or Z → INSERT
DLE
87
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
Clear
Data
Param- Func-
prote-
Function eter Mode tion Operation
ction
write=1 key
key
Memory all clear
RESET
M/T : AND DELETE
At Path1 : RESET
AND 1
f Power
ON Path2 : RESET AND 2
only)
Clearing a program
M/T : DELETE
off(PS101)
PMC RAM *
At Main CPU : X AND 0 (O)
Power
ON Loader is controlled : X AND 5
Additional SRAM
area clear M/T : O (O) AND DELETE
88
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
1.13
WARNING SCREEN
DISPLAYED WHEN
AN OPTION IS
CHANGED
D Warning screen This CNC displays a warning screen when the configuration of the
options using the SRAM area is changed. The data for the function
indicated on the screen is cleared the next time the system is turned on.
WARNING
NOTE (*1)
Mark* varies with the parameter settings. Two or more
function names may be displayed.
89
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
D Allocation error screen When an option which uses the SRAM area is added, the system software
may require more SRAM than is currently installed in the system. In this
case, an allocation error screen appears the first time the system is turned
on after the addition of the option, thus restoring the state existing before
the addition.
NOTE
When the currently installed SRAM is not sufficient,
additional SRAM can be mounted. Newly installed SRAM
must be cleared before it can be used.
Operation:When turning on the power, hold down the
following keys:
O + DELETE
for M/T series
90
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
1.14 System software can be replaced only with compatible system software.
Otherwise, the first time the CNC is turned on after the system software
WARNING SCREEN is replaced, the following screen will be displayed and the system will not
DISPLAYED WHEN be activated:
SYSTEM SOFTWARE
IS REPLACED
(SYSTEM LABEL
CHECK ERROR)
BOF1–01
NOT READY
In this case, perform memory all clear (by holding down the RESET and
DELETE MDI keys then turning on the power) or reinstall the original system
software.
91
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
1.15.1
Screen Display and
Operation
D Screen display
1. Press the SYSTEM function key.
MAINTENANCE INFORM
aaa
bbb
ccc
ddd
11 lines eee
fff
...
nnn
|OVER|EDIT|spaces:2078 33:1
92
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
Status display
⋅ OVER/INSERT : OVER : Overwrite mode ; INSERT: Insert
mode
⋅ EDIT/VIEW : EDIT : Editing allowed ; VIEW : Editing inhi
bited
⋅ Number of empty character spaces
⋅ Current cursor line
⋅ Current cursor column
D Screen operation The maintenance information screen has view mode and edit mode, which
are selected by pressing the [END] or [EDIT] soft key.
Initially, view mode is selected. To start editing, select edit mode by
pressing the [(OPRT)] and [EDIT] keys. When the editing is completed,
press the [END] key. Then, select [STORE] or [IGNORE]. Unless
[STORE] is selected, the edited data will be lost at next power–up.
To scroll the screen showing the recorded information, press a cursor key
or page key on the MDI panel.
The following keys are used for editing (character input) and viewing:
Operation table
Mode Key Description
View Soft keys Allows editing.
[EDIT] Displays the beginning or the end.
[JUMP]
Cursor key Scrolls the screen up or down.
Page key Scrolls the screen up or down in units of whole screens.
Edit Soft keys
[END] Ends editing. Select whether to store the edited data.
[ALLDEL] Clears all maintenance information. (This key is enabled when the MDC bit (bit 3 of parameter 3118) is
set to 1.)
[I/O] Reads or punches the maintenance information.
93
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
Edit Jump
Jump
BEGIN- CANCEL
END
ING
Execution
EXEC CANCEL
94
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
1.15.2
Maintenance The maintenance information can be read and punched.
When the maintenance information is input from or output to a memory
Information card, a file name MAINTINF.DAT is used.
Input/Output
(1) Format
%%
Data
(2) Reading
When a MAINTINF.DAT file generated in the format shown above is
read, the data is added at the end of the existing maintenance
information.
NOTE
1 A TAB code is converted to one to four blanks, depending
on the input position.
2 80h to 90h and E0h to EBh are assumed as prefix codes of
double–byte characters. Reading these codes alone is
inhibited.
3 Control codes (00H to 1FH) except TAB and LF are
discarded in reading.
4 %% cannot be input.
(3) Punching
All maintenance information is output in the format shown above.
95
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
1.16 When VGA screen display is selected (NVG bit (bit 7 of parameter 3119)
is set to 0), the color scheme of the VGA screen can be set on the color
COLOR SETTING setting screen.
SCREEN
1.16.1
Screen Display
1. Press the SYSTEM function key.
COLORING O0000N00000
1.16.2
Color Setting
D Changing a color
(color palette value)
1. Press the [(OPRT)] soft key. The following operation soft keys appear.
2. Move the cursor to the color number corresponding to the color palette
value to be changed.
The current color palette values of individual color elements are
displayed.
3. Select a desired color element by pressing the [RED], [GREEN], or
[BLUE] operation soft key.
Two or more color elements can be simultaneously selected.
96
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
CAN EXEC
3. To store the current color palette values in the selected area, press the
[EXEC] operation soft key. To cancel the storage, press the [CAN]
operation soft key or the leftmost key.
D Calling colors
(color palette values)
STORE CALL COLOR1 COLOR2 COLOR3
CAN EXEC
3. To call the color palette values from the selected area, press the
[EXEC] operation soft key. If no color palette value is stored, this step
cannot be executed.
To stop calling, press the [CAN] operation soft key or the leftmost key.
97
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
1.16.3
Parameters
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3119 NVG
98
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
1.16.4
Notes
(1) At power–up, the color scheme of the screen is determined by the
setting in the COLOR1 area (parameters). If no data is stored in the
COLOR1 area, the last color scheme before power–down is applied.
(2) The standard color data specified in parameters must not be changed
by direct MDI key input. When changing the parameter data, set and
store the new data on the color setting screen.
(3) When a wrong value is specified in a standard color data parameter,
the screen may not be displayed. If this occurs, turn the power on
again, while pressing the DELETE and RESET keys. This clears the whole
stored color scheme and restores the FANUC standard color scheme
instead.
99
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
1.17 Depending on the eye level and the viewing angle of the operator, the LCD
may be hard to read. This problem can be solved by adjusting the contrast.
CONTRAST The contrast of a monochrome LCD can be adjusted.
ADJUSTMENT
1. Press the OFFSET
SETTING function key.
SETTING(HANDY)
PARAMETER WRITE = 1(0:DISABLE 1: ENABLE)
TV CHECK = 0(0:OFF 1:ON)
PUNCH CODE = 0(0:EIA 1:ISO)
INPUT UNIT = 0(0:MM 1:INCH)
I/O CHANNEL = 0(0–3:CHANNEL NO.)
SEQUENCE NO. = 0(0:OFF 1:ON)
TAPE EORMAT = 0(0:NO CNV 1:F15)
SEQUENCE STOP = 0(PROGRAM NO.)
SEQUENCE STOP = 0(SEQUENCE NO.)
100
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
1.18 When the Power Motion series is used as an additional axis (slave) of the
CNC, the power motion manager allows the slave data to be displayed and
POWER MOTION set by the CNC.
MANAGER The power motion manager enables the following display and setting:
(1) Current position display (absolute/machine coordinates)
(2) Parameter display and setting
(3) Diagnosis display
(4) System configuration screen display
(5) Alarm display
The Power Motion series that can be used as the slave is a β amplifier with
I/O Link.
1.18.1
Parameter
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
0960 PMN MD2 MD1 SLV
The parameters are input or output in the program format, no matter which
I/O device is selected.
PMN The power motion manager function is:
0 : Enabled.
1 : Disabled. (Communication with the slave is not performed.)
1.18.2
Screen Display
1. Press the SYSTEM
function key.
2. Press the continuous menu key several times. The [PMM] soft
key appears.
3. Press the [PMM] soft key. The system configuration screen, which is
the initial screen of the power motion manager, appears. The screen
has the following soft keys (function selection soft keys).
The currently active soft key is displayed in reverse video. Pressing a soft
key enables the corresponding function, as indicated below:
101
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
MESSAGE , etc.).
NOTE
After another screen is displayed by pressing a function key,
pressing the function key, restores the initial status
SYSTEM
of this function. That is, the soft keys shown above are
restored. The data that was being input is canceled.
D System configuration This screen displays the system software information of the slave. The
screen screen is displayed first when the power motion manager function is
selected. This screen is automatically displayed also at the termination
of the function.
1. Press the [SYSTEM] function selection soft key. The following soft
keys are displayed together with the screen displayed when SYSTEM
was last selected. The currently active soft key is displayed in reverse
video.
2. Press the [SYSTEM] soft key again. The system configuration screen
appears. While this screen is displayed, the [SYSTEM] soft key is left
displayed in reverse video.
102
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
Sample screen: Series and edition of the servo unit β series system list
D Parameter screen The parameters necessary for the functions of the slave must be specified
in advance.
1. Press the [SYSTEM] function selection soft key. The following soft
keys appear.
The screen displays just the bit and decimal data. For details of the
parameters, refer to the connection manual of the corresponding Power
Motion unit.
103
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
[ NO.SRC ][ ][ ][ ][ INPUT ]
3. Enter a desired number in the key–in field by using MDI numeric keys.
Then, press the [NO.SRC] soft key. The search starts.
D Setting a parameter
A parameter of a slave Power Motion unit can be directly set from the
CNC.
[ NO.SRC ][ ][ ][ ][ INPUT ]
D Diagnosis screen This screen shows the current status of the slave.
1. Press the [SYSTEM] function selection soft key. The following soft
keys appear:
2. Press the [DGNOS] soft key. The diagnosis screen appears. The
displayed data is basically the same as the data displayed on the
parameter screen.
For details of the diagnosis information, refer to the connection
manual of the corresponding Power Motion unit.
D Current position display The screen shows the current position on the workpiece coordinate
system or machine coordinate system.
1. Press the [POS] function selection soft key. The following soft keys
appear:
[ WORK ][ ][MACHIN][ ][ ]
2. To see the absolute coordinate screen, press the [WORK] soft key. To
see the machine coordinate screen, press the [MACHIN] soft key.
104
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
1 1267900
F 3500
[ WORK ][ ][ MACHIN ][ ][ ]
D Alarm screen If an alarm is issued during operation, the group number of the slave
causing the alarm is indicated at the right end of the message field on the
screen. Check the details on the alarm screen. For example, (13) means
that the first and third power motion units are in the alarm state.
1. Press the [MSG] function selection soft key. Just the error code is
displayed on the screen.
105
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
D Operating the active The active slave is subjected to the ZOOM function, which will be
slave described later, and parameter overwrite. The title of the active slave is
displayed in a color different from the display color of the other slave
titles.
D Single–slave display/ Whether the screen displays the data of just a single unit or of four units
Four–slave display in four segments is specified in the SLV bit (bit 0 of parameter 960).
When five or more slaves are connected, the four–slave display has two
or more pages. To see the slave data that is not displayed on the current
page, press soft key [±NEXT].
3.GROUP2 / β 4.GROUP3 / β
106
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
D Guidance message While the following soft keys are being displayed, a guidance message
is displayed in the message field.
[ WORK ][ ][MACHIN ][ ][ ]
When the soft keys are displayed as shown above, ”SELECT ACTIVE
SLAVE [>]” is displayed.
When the soft keys are displayed as shown above, ”SELECT ACTIVE
SLAVE [↓] [↑]” is displayed.
D Key–in field When the [(OPRT)] soft key is pressed, the message line may turn into a
key–in field as required. The numeric data input by using MDI keys is
displayed after the prompt (>).
On the parameter and diagnosis screens, the key–in field appears when
just a numeric value is input. The soft key [(OPRT)] need not be pressed.
107
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
1.18.3
Parameter Input/Output
D Saving parameters Parameters can be saved in CNC memory or a memory card as a data file
of program format. Specify the first digit of the registration program
number in parameter 8760. Programs with predetermined numbers are
created for individual slaves. When the parameters are saved in CNC
memory, a program having the specified program number is created.
When the parameters are saved in a memory card, a file is created, to
which the file name consists of the specified program number and an
extension PMM.
Example: When parameter 8760 is set to 8000
The program number for group n is 8000 + n*10.
The group number n is indicated in the title area of each slave.
CAUTION
In case that the parameters are saved in a memory card, If
the specified program number already exists on memory
card, the corresponding program is overwritten with new
data.
Specify a desired input device in the MD1 and MD2 bits (bits 1 and 2 of
parameter 960). Connect a memory card. Alternatively, check the free
area of CNC memory. Then, follow the steps given below:
[ NO.SRC ][ ][ ][ ][ INPUT ]
3. Press the continuous menu key . The following soft keys appear:
[ ][ READ ][ PUNCH ][ ][ ]
4. Press the [READ] soft key. The following soft keys appear:
[ ][ ][ ][CANCEL ][ EXEC ]
108
B–63005EN/01 1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION
D Writing parameters The data file of parameters saved in CNC memory or a memory card as
a program is written into the slave determined by the program number.
The program number and memory device are determined as described in
”Saving parameters.”
[ NO.SRC ][ ][ ][ ][ INPUT ]
[ ][ READ ][ PUNCH ][ ][ ]
4. Press the [PUNCH] soft key. The following soft keys appear:
[ ][ ][ ][CANCEL ][ EXEC ]
1.18.4
Notes
D Connecting an I/O Link When the Power Motion series is used as a slave of an I/O Link, the CNC
assigns I/O addresses. The salve data is input and output in units of 16
bytes. Therefore, 128 input/output points are necessary. Up to eight
slaves can be connected.
D Ignoring the power After the data necessary for each slave connected is set and checked, the
motion manager function communication of the power motion manager (PMM) can be stopped to
send a command from the CNC ladder to the slave.
When the PMN bit (bit 3 of parameter 960) is set to 1, all communication
between CNC and the slave via the I/O Link is open to the ladder.
While the bit is held 1, the screen shows just the title, function name, and
other items that are independent of the communication. The following
message appears to indicate that communication has stopped.
109
1. DISPLAY AND OPERATION B–63005EN/01
D Data input/output by I/O When the power motion manager is used, the function for data
Link input/output by I/O Link cannot be used.
D Alarm
(1) CNC
When a CNC alarm status is detected, the screen is automatically
switched to the CNC alarm screen. Check the details of the alarm. If
necessary, display and select the power motion manager screen again
by pressing function key SYSTEM
.
(2) Slave
A guidance message is usually displayed in the message field. If a
slave alarm is detected, the corresponding slave group number is
displayed at the right end.
Display the alarm screen to check the details.
D Data protection key When the data protection key of the CNC is turned on, parameters cannot
be input to CNC memory.
110
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
2 HARDWARE
111
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
2.1
STRUCTURE
Servo amplifier
I/O Link
112
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
2.2
OVERVIEW OF
HARDWARE
2.2.1
Series 16/160
113
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
C board
Basic system
CAP–II board
RISC board
Option
Without slots, or
with 2 slots, or
with 4 slots
Loader control board
114
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
2.2.2
Series 18/180
Motherboard
Serial communication board
CPU for CNC control
Remote buffer/DNC1/DNC2/HDLC ⋅ Power supply
⋅ 2–axis to 8–axis control
⋅ Spindle control
⋅ LCD/MDI
⋅ I/O link
Sub–CPU board ⋅ PMC–RB5/RB6
⋅ Analog output/high–speed DI
⋅ RS–232C x 2
Sub–CPU for 2–path control ⋅ Memory card interface
⋅ 2–axis to 6–axis control ⋅ Personal computer function
⋅ Spindle interface
⋅ Analog output
C board
Basic system
CAP–II board
Option
115
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
2.3
CONFIGURATION OF
PRINTED CIRCUIT
BOARD
CONNECTORS
AND CARDS
2.3.1
FS16i/18i Motherboard
D Specification
Name Specification
Series 16 motherboard A20B–8100–0130
Series 18 motherboard A20B–8100–0135
116
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
D Connector mounting
location
Inverter PCB
Battery
Rear of unit
COP10A
CP1B
CA54
JD36B JD1A
Motherboard
CN3 CN8B
JNA
MCRD1
Motherboard
CP1B
CA54
JD36B JD1A
117
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
118
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
DIMM DIMM
module module
socket socket
JD36B JD1A
Motherboard
119
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
(1) (2)
FROM module SRAM module
JD36B JD1A
Motherboard
120
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
(3)
DRAM module
Connector
CPU card
Side–B
121
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
2.3.2
FS160i/180i
Motherboard with the
PC Function
D Specification
Name Specification
Series 160 motherboard A20B–8100–0140
Series 180 motherboard A20B–8100–0145
122
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
D Connector mounting
location
Inverter PCB
Battery
Rear of unit
COP10A
CNY1 CD34
CNH1
JD36B JD1A
Motherbord
CN3 CN8B
JNA
PCMCIA2
Motherboard
CNY1 CD34
123
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
124
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
DIMM DIMM
module module
socket socket
JD33 JD36A
CA55
CA54 CD32
Motherboard
125
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
(1) (2)
FROM module SRAM module
Connector
Connector Connector
DIMM module
socket
CA54 CD32
Motherboard
126
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
(3) (4)
DRAM module DRAM module
Connector
Connector
2.3.3
Inverter P.C.B
D Specification
Name Specification
Inverter 10.4”, color, for 2 slots A20B–2002–0500
8.4”, color, for 2 slots A20B–2002–0501
10.4”, color, for 4 slots A20B–8100–0200
8.4”, color, for 4 slots A20B–8100–0201
7.2”, 9.5”, monochrome, for 2 slots A20B–2002–0480
7.2”, 9.5”, monochrome, for 4 slots A20B–2002–0550
127
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
D Connector mounting
location 1) For 4 slots
Inverter P.C.B
CP8
Rear of unit
2) For 2 slots
Inverter P.C.B
CP8
Battery
CN39A CN39B
Rear of unit
Motherboard
128
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
D Connector mounting
location (single printed 1) For 4 slots
circuit board)
CP8
CP1
CN3
2) For 2 slots
CN39A CN39B
CP8
CP1
CN3
129
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
2.3.4
C language Board,
Serial Communication
Board, CAP–II Board
D Specification
Name Specification
PMC–RE board A20B–8100–0150
C language board A20B–8100–0151
Serial communication board A Remote buffer/DNC2 A20B–8100–0152
Serial communication board B DNC1 A20B–8100–0153
CAP–II board A20B–8100–0154
D Connector mounting
location 1) PMC–RE board
JNA
F–bus backplane connector
CP8B
2) C language board
JNA
F–bus backplane connector
130
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
JNA
F–bus backplane connector
JD28A JD6A
JNA
F–bus backplane connector
JD28A JD6A
5) CAP–II board
JNA
F–bus backplane connector
CP8B
131
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
Connector
CP8B
132
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
2.3.5
Sub–CPU Board
D Specification
Name Specification
Sub–CPU board A20B–8001–0630
D Connector mounting
location
JNA
F–bus backplane connector
(1) (2)
Axis control card CPU card (Mounted on the CPU card)
JNA
Connector
DIMM module
socket
Connector
CA54 JA41 JA40
133
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
2.3.6
RISC Board
D Specification
Name Specification
RISC board A20B–8100–0170
D Connector mounting
location
JNA
F–bus backplane connector
134
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
2.3.7
Data Server Board
D Specification
Name Specification
Data server board A20B–8100–0160
D Connector mounting
location
CNH1
CD27
135
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
2.3.8
Loader Control Board
D Specification
Name Specification
Loader control board A20B–8100–0190
D Connector mounting
location
JNA
F–bus backplane connector
CA54 JD1A
(1) (2)
Axis control card CPU card
JNA Connector
Connector
136
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
2.3.9
HSSB Interface Board
D Specification
Name Specification
HSSB interface board A20B–8001–0640
D Connector mounting
location
JNA
F–bus backplane connector
COP7
137
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
2.4
LIST OF UNITS AND
PRINTED CIRCUIT
BOARDS
2.4.1
Basic Unit Model Name Drawing number Remarks
FS16i Basic unit A1, 8.4”, color Without slots A02B–0236–C501 With soft keys
(5+2)
Basic unit A2, 8.4”, color With 2 slots A02B–0236–C502 With soft keys
(5+2)
Basic unit A3, 8.4”, color With 4 slots A02B–0236–C503 With soft keys
(5+2)
Basic unit A4, 10.4”, color Without slots A02B–0236–C511 With soft keys
(10+2)
Basic unit A5, 10.4”, color With 2 slots A02B–0236–C521 With soft keys
(10+2)
Basic unit A6, 10.4”, color With 4 slots A02B–0236–C531 With soft keys
(10+2)
Basic unit A7, 10.4”, color Without slots A02B–0236–C521 With touch pad
Basic unit A8, 10.4”, color With 2 slots A02B–0236–C522 With touch pad
Basic unit A9, 10.4”, color With 4 slots A02B–0236–C523 With touch pad
Basic unit A10, 7.2”, Without slots A02B–0236–C531 With soft keys
monochrome (5+2)
Basic unit A11, 7.2”, With 2 slots A02B–0236–C532 With soft keys
monochrome (5+2)
Basic unit A12, 7.2”, With 4 slots A02B–0236–C533 With soft keys
monochrome (5+2)
Basic unit A13, 9.5”, Without slots A02B–0236–C541 With soft keys
monochrome (10+2)
Basic unit A14, 9.5”, With 2 slots A02B–0236–C542 With soft keys
monochrome (10+2)
Basic unit A15, 9.5”, With 4 slots A02B–0236–C543 With soft keys
monochrome (10+2)
FS160i Basic unit B1, 10.4”, color Without slots A02B–0236–C551 With soft keys
with (10+2)
PC
func- Basic unit B2, 10.4”, color With 2 slots A02B–0236–C552 With soft keys
tion (10+2)
Basic unit B3, 10.4”, color With 4 slots A02B–0236–C553 With soft keys
(10+2)
Basic unit B4, 10.4”, color Without slots A02B–0236–C561 With touch pad
Basic unit B5, 10.4”, color With 2 slots A02B–0236–C562 With touch pad
Basic unit B6, 10.4”, color With 4 slots A02B–0236–C563 With touch pad
Basic unit B7, 10.4”, color Without slots A02B–0236–C571 Without soft keys
Basic unit B8, 10.4”, color With 2 slots A02B–0236–C572 Without soft keys
Basic unit B9, 10.4”, color With 4 slots A02B–0236–C573 Without soft keys
138
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
139
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
2.4.2
MDI Unit Model Name Drawing number Remarks
FS16i/18i Separate–type MDI, T A02B–0236–C120#TBR English keys
small keys
For 8.4”/7.2” LCD A02B–0236–C120#TBS Symbolic keys
(horizontal type)
M A02B–0236–C120#MBR English keys
A02B–0236–C120#MBS Symbolic keys
Separate–type MDI, T A02B–0236–C121#TBR English keys
standard keys
For 8.4”/7.2” LCD A02B–0236–C121#TBS Symbolic keys
(horizontal/vertical type)
M A02B–0236–C121#MBR English keys
A02B–0236–C121#MBS Symbolic keys
Separate–type MDI, T A02B–0236–C125#TBR English keys
standard keys
For 10.4”/9.5” LCD A02B–0236–C125#TBS Symbolic keys
(horizontal type)
M A02B–0236–C125#MBR English keys
A02B–0236–C125#MBS Symbolic keys
Separate–type MDI, T A02B–0236–C126#TBR English keys
standard keys
For 10.4”/9.5” LCD A02B–0236–C126#TBS Symbolic keys
(vertical type)
M A02B–0236–C126#MBR English keys
A02B–0236–C126#MBS Symbolic keys
Separate–type MDI for T A02B–0236–C125#TFBR English keys
CAP–II
For 10.4”/9.5” LCD A02B–0236–C125#TFBS Symbolic keys
(horizontal type)
Separate–type MDI, T A02B–0236–C126#TFBR English keys
standard keys
For 10.4”/9.5” LCD A02B–0236–C126#TFBS Symbolic keys
(vertical type)
FS160i/180i Separate–type MDI, T A02B–0236–C127#TBR English keys
standard keys
For 10.4” LCD A02B–0236–C127#TBS Symbolic keys
(vertical type)
M A02B–0236–C127#MBR English keys
A02B–0236–C127#MBS Symbolic keys
Separate–type FA full A02B–0236–C130#EC English keys
keyboard
For 10.4” LCD A02B–0236–C130#JC Japanese keys
(vertical type)
140
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
2.4.3
Printed Circuit Boards Type Name Drawing number ID Remarks
of the Control Unit Master PCB Motherboard Without per- A20B–8100–0130 D5 16i
sonal computer
A20B–8100–0135 C5 18i
With personal A20B–8100–0140 CC 160i
computer
A20B–8100–0145 EC 180i
Card PCB CPU card A20B–3300–0050 01 Pentium
A20B–3300–0070 09 486DX2
Display A A20B–3300–0020 1E 10.4”, color
control card
B A20B–3300–0021 1A 8.4”, color
C A20B–3300–0023 06 9.5”, mono-
chrome
D A20B–3300–0024 02 7.2”, mono-
chrome,
graphic
E A20B–3300–0025 03 7.2”, mono-
chrome
Axis control card A17B–3300–0100 X3 8 axes
A17B–3300–0101 X2 6 axes
A20B–3300–0030 X1 4 axes
A20B–3300–0031 X0 2 axes
Personal computer card A15L–0001–0052#A C9 486DX2
DIMM DRAM module A20B–3900–0040 87 12M
module
A20B–3900–0041 86 8M
A20B–3900–0042 85 4M
A20B–3900–0030 82 2M
A20B–3900–0031 81 1M
SRAM module A20B–3900–0020 25 3M
A20B–3900–0060 24 2M
A20B–3900–0061 23 1M
A20B–3900–0052 22 512K
A20B–3900–0053 21 256K
FROM module A20B–3900–0010 47 16M
A20B–3900–0011 45 12M
A20B–3900–0012 43 8M
A20B–3900–0013 42 6M
A20B–3900–0014 41 4M
A20B–3900–0015 40 2M
141
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
2.4.4
Others Name Drawing number Remarks
Linear Scale interface unit (basic 4 axes) A02B–0236–C201
Linear Scale interface unit (additional 4 axes) A02B–0236–C202
142
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
2.5
REPLACING THE
WARNING
MOTHERBOARD Only those personnel who have received approved safety
and maintenance training may perform this replacement
work.
When opening the cabinet and replacing the board, be
careful not to touch the high–voltage circuits (marked and
fitted with an insulating cover). Touching the uncovered
high–voltage circuits presents an extremely dangerous
electric shock hazard.
CAUTION
Before starting replacement work, back up the contents
(such as parameters and programs) of the SRAM memory
of the CNC. Otherwise, the contents of the SRAM memory
may be lost during replacement work.
D Replacement procedure
1) Unplug the connectors for the fans and memory backup battery from
the top of the CNC unit, then remove the yellow cover.
CAUTION
With a CNC unit that has an indicator for the touch pad, the
connectors CN1 and CD37 connected to the left side of the
unit, as viewed from the rear of the unit, must be unplugged
before removing the yellow cover.
143
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
2) Unplug the connectors MCRD1 (or PCMCIA2), CN3, and CN8 from
the printed circuit board, then replace the motherboard.
PCB
CP1 CN3
CN3
CN8
Motherboard
MCRD1
or
PCMCIA2
Flat cable for soft keys
144
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
2.6
MOUNTING AND
WARNING
DEMOUNTING CARD Only those personnel who have received approved safety
PCBS and maintenance training may perform this replacement
work.
When opening the cabinet and replacing a card PCB, be
careful not to touch the high–voltage circuits (marked and
fitted with an insulating cover). Touching the uncovered
high–voltage circuits presents an extremely dangerous
electric shock hazard.
CAUTION
Before starting replacement work, back up the contents
(such as parameters and programs) of the SRAM memory
of the CNC. Otherwise, the contents of the SRAM memory
may be lost during replacement work.
145
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
2.6.1
Demounting a Card 1) Pull outward the claw of each of the four spacers used to secure the
PCB card PCB, then release each latch. (See Fig. a.)
2) Extract the card PCB upward. (See Fig. b.)
Card PCB
Fig. a Spacer
Connector
Card PCB
Fig. b Spacer
Connector
146
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
2.6.2
Mounting a Card PCB 1) Check that the claw of each of the four spacers is latched outward, then
insert the card PCB into the connector. (See Fig. c.)
2) Push the claw of each spacer downward to secure the card PCB. (See
Fig. d.)
Card PCB
Fig. c Spacer
Connector
Card PCB
Fig. d Spacer
Connector
147
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
2.7
MOUNTING AND
WARNING
DEMOUNTING DIMM Only those personnel who have received approved safety
MODULES and maintenance training may perform this replacement
work.
When opening the cabinet and replacing a module, be
careful not to touch the high–voltage circuits (marked and
fitted with an insulating cover). Touching the uncovered
high–voltage circuits presents an extremely dangerous
electric shock hazard.
CAUTION
Before starting replacement work, back up the contents
(such as parameters and programs) of the SRAM memory
of the CNC. Otherwise, the contents of the SRAM memory
may be lost during replacement work.
Before replacing an SRAM module, be sure to back up the
contents of the SRAM module.
148
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
2.7.1
Demounting a DIMM 1) Open the claw of the socket outward. (See Fig. a.)
Module 2) Extract the module slantly upward. (See Fig. b.)
2.7.2
Mounting a DIMM 1) Insert the module slantly into the module socket, with side B facing
module upward. (See Fig. b.)
2) Push the module downward until it is locked. (See Fig. c.)
Fig. a
Fig. b
Fig. c
149
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
2.8
REPLACING FUSE ON
WARNING
CONTROL UNIT Before replacing a blown fuse, locate and remove the cause
of the blown fuse.
For this reason, only those personnel who have received
approved safety and maintenance training may perform this
replacement work.
When opening the cabinet and replacing a fuse, be careful
not to touch the high–voltage circuits (marked and fitted
with an insulating cover). Touching the uncovered
high–voltage circuits presents an extremely dangerous
electric shock hazard.
Rear of unit
CP1A
CP1B
FUSE
Fuse
150
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
Rear of unit
CP1A
CP1B
FUSE
Fuse
151
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
2.9
REPLACING
BATTERY
D Replacement procedure
When a lithium battery is used
Prepare a new lithium battery (ordering code: A02B–0200–K102
(FANUC specification: A98L–0031–0012)).
1) Turn on the power to the CNC. After about 30 seconds, turn off the
power.
2) Remove the old battery from the top of the CNC control unit.
First, unplug the battery connector, then take the battery out of its
case.
The battery case of a control unit without option slots is located at the
top end of the unit as shown in the figure of the previous page. The
battery case of a control unit with 2 slots or 4 slots is located in the
central area of the top of the unit (between fans).
3) Insert a new battery and reconnect the connector.
Battery case
Connector
Lithium battery
A02B–0200–K102
WARNING
Using other than the recommended battery may result in the
battery exploding. Replace the battery only with the
specified battery (A02B–0200–K102).
152
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
CAUTION
Steps 1) to 3) should be completed within 30 minutes (or
within 5 minutes for the 160i/180i with the PC function). Do
not leave the control unit without a battery for any longer
than the specified period. Otherwise, the contents of
memory may be lost.
If steps 1) to 3) may not be completed within 30 minutes,
save all contents of the CMOS memory to the memory card
beforehand. Thus, if the contents of the CMOS memory are
lost, the contents can be restored easily.
For the method of operation, refer to the maintenance
manual.
153
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
CAUTION
1 Install the battery case (A02B–0236–C281) in a location
where the batteries can be replaced even when the power
to the control unit is on.
2 The battery cable connector is attached to the control unit
by means of a simple lock system. To prevent the connector
from being disconnected due to the weight of the cable or
tension within the cable, fix the cable section within 50 cm
of the connector.
154
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
Replacing
commercial alkaline dry
cells (size D) 1) Prepare two alkaline dry cells (size D) commercially available.
2) Turn on the power to the Series 16i/18i/160i/180i.
3) Remove the battery case cover.
4) Replace the cells, paying careful attention to their orientation.
5) Reinstall the cover onto the battery case.
CAUTION
When replacing the alkaline dry cells while the power is off,
use the same procedure as that for lithium battery
replacement described above.
Cover
Mounting hole x 4
Battery case
155
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
2.10
REPLACING FAN
WARNING
MOTORS When opening the cabinet and replacing a fan motor, be
careful not to touch the high–voltage circuits (marked and
fitted with an insulating cover).
Touching the uncovered high–voltage circuits presents an
extremely dangerous electric shock hazard.
Replacement procedure
3. Detach the latch securing the fan motor, then demount the fan motor
( (2) of Fig. a).
4. Insert a new fan motor into the fan case ( (3) of Fig. a), then reconnect
the connector.
156
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
Fig. a
(1) Connector
(2) Fan (3) Fan case
3. Detach the latch securing the fan cover ( (3) of Fig. b), then demount
the fan cover from the unit.
4. The fan is secured to the fan cover. Detach the latch, then demount
the fan motor ( (2) of Fig. b).
5. Install a new fan motor onto the fan cover. Then, reinstall the fan
cover onto the unit, and reconnect the connector.
157
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
Fig. b
(3) Fan cover
(2) Fan
(1) Connector
158
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
2.11
REPLACING LCD
WARNING
BACKLIGHT Only those personnel who have received approved safety
and maintenance training may perform this replacement
work.
When opening the cabinet and replacing a unit, be careful
not to touch the high–voltage circuits (marked and fitted
with an insulating cover).
Touching the uncovered high–voltage circuits presents an
extremely dangerous electric shock hazard.
CAUTION
Before starting replacement work, back up the contents
(such as parameters and programs) of the SRAM memory
of the CNC. Otherwise, the contents of the SRAM memory
may be lost during replacement work.
D Backlight ordering
information Backlight Ordering code
For 7.2” LCD unit Manufactured by Hitachi A61L–0001–0142#BL
Manufactured by Sharp A61L–0001–0142#BLS
For 8.4” LCD unit A61L–0001–0162#BL
For 9.5” LCD unit A61L–0001–0154#BL
For 10.4” LCD unit A61L–0001–0163#BL
159
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
D Replacement procedure
1) Detach the escutcheon from the CNC.
Escutcheon
2) As shown below, unplug the connectors CP1 and CN8 to detach the
LCD unit from the CNC unit.
LCD unit
CP1
CN8
CN8
160
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
CN8
Backlight
Connector
PCB CN8
Backlight
161
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
3)–3 For the 7.2” and 9.5” LCD units (monochrome) manufactured by
Hitachi
Remove the three brackets from the left part on the front of the LCD
unit, and remove the cover. Then, the backlight is exposed. Replace
the backlight with a new one.
Connector
Bracket
Backlight
Connector
Backlight
162
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
2.12 The performance of the heat exchanger degrades due to a buildup of dirt.
Clean the heat exchanger periodically. The cleaning interval depends on
MAINTENANCE OF the installation environment. So, clean the heat exchanger at appropriate
HEAT EXCHANGER intervals according to the level of dirt built up.
OF HEAT PIPE TYPE
WARNING
High voltage is applied to the heat exchanger of heat pipe
type. Before maintaining the heat exchanger of heat pipe
type, always turn off the power to the CNC.
When opening the cabinet and replacing a heat exchanger
of heat pipe type, be careful not to touch the high–voltage
circuits (marked and fitted with an insulating cover).
Touching the uncovered high–voltage circuits presents an
extremely dangerous electric shock hazard.
163
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
1 Before cleaning and replacing the air filter, turn off the fan power
supply.
4 When the filter is dirty extremely, wash it with a solution of water and
neutral detergent, and rinse it with fresh water, then allow it dry
naturally.
Alternatively, replace it with a new filter (use only the specified filter).
5 Set the cleaned or new filter. Next, align the claws with the grooves,
then press them to reinstall the cover. Check that the cover is not
removed when it is pulled toward you.
164
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
1 Before cleaning the heat exchanger, turn off the fan power supply.
2 Demount the external fan unit from the main body of the heat
exchanger.
Remove the two mounting screws (A) used for mounting the external fan unit, then
demount the unit by sliding it downward. Next, disconnect the fan power cable and
ground wire. Remove mounting screw (B).
1 Remove any buildup of dust, dirt, and mist from the fan motor and fan
mounting case with a dry waste cloth. If dirt such as mist cannot be
removed easily, use a waste cloth moistened with a solution of water
and neutral detergent after squeezing it softly. In this case, be careful
not to allow a solution of water and neutral detergent to enter the
electric circuitry such as the rotor of the fan motor.
165
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
1 Demount the heat exchanger from the unit, then remove dust and mist
from the fan by blowing air or by using a dry waste cloth or brush.
1 Detach the internal fan unit, terminal block, and cables from the main
body.
Main body
2 Clean the fan by using a brush and a solution of water and neutral
detergent. At this time, be careful not to bend a vane.
3 After cleaning, dry the heat exchanger and fan unit sufficiently.
D Reassembly
After cleaning the fan unit and heat exchanger, follow the steps below.
2 Reinstall the fan unit at the original location. At this time, reconnect
the fan power cable and ground wire correctly.
166
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
2.13
ENVIRONMENTAL The control units and various peripheral units provided by FANUC are
CONDITIONS designed to be accommodated in closed cabinets. Usable cabinets are as
OUTSIDE CABINET follows:
D Cabinets manufactured by machine tool builders to accommodate a
control unit and peripheral units
D Cabinets for a flexible turnkey system provided by FANUC
D Teach pendant manufactured by machine tool builders to
accommodate an indicator, MDI unit, and operator’s panel
D Similar cabinets
These cabinets must be installed under the following environmental
conditions:
Condition Without PC function With PC function
Ambient tem- Operating 0°C to 45°C 5°C to 40°C
perature
Storage, trans- –20°C to 60°C
portation
Temperature 1.1°C/minute maximum 0.3°C/minute maximum
variation
Humidity Usually 75% or less 10% to 75%
(relative humidity) (relative humidity)
No condensation No condensation
Short term 95% or less 10% to 90%
(within 1 month) (relative humidity) (relative humidity)
No condensation No condensation
Vibration Operating 0.5 G or less
Non–operating 1.0 G or less
Atmosphere Normal machining factory environment. (A separate
study is required when the cabinets are used in an envi-
ronment exposed to relatively high levels of dust, cool-
ant, and organic solvents.)
167
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
2.14
POWER Name Power consumption (W)
NOTE
The power consumption depends on the ISA expansion
board used.
168
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
2.15.1 The cables used with a CNC machine tool are classified as indicated
Separation of Signal below. Handle the cables of each group according to the descriptions in
the ”Action” column.
Lines
Group Signal Action
Primary side AC power line Bind the cables of this group sep-
arately from the cables of grou
groupss
Secondary side AC power line B and C(*1), or electromagneti-
cally shield the cables of this
AC/DC power lines (including servo motor group from the cables of groups
A and spindle motor power lines) B and C(*2). According to the de-
scriptions
scri tions of noise suppressors
su ressors
AC/DC solenoid in Section 2.15.4, attach a spark
killer or diode to the solenoid and
AC/DC relay relay.
169
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
NOTE
1 Separate binding is to separate the bound cables of one
group at least 10 cm from the bound cables of another
group.
2 Electromagnetic shielding is to shield the bound cables of
one group from the bound cables of another group with a
grounded metal (iron) plate.
3 If the CNC–MDI cable is not longer than 30 cm, shielding is
not required.
Cabinet
Duct
To opera-
tor’s panel,
motor, or
other units
Cables of group A Cross section
Shielding plate
170
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
2.15.2 With a CNC machine tool, three ground systems are used.
Grounding (1) Signal ground system (SG)
Signal ground (SG) provides a reference voltage (0 V) for the electric
signal system.
(2) Frame ground system (FG)
The purposes of frame ground (FG) are to ensure safety and to provide
shielding from external and internal noises. Specifically, the frames
of equipment, unit cases, panels, inter–unit interface cables, and so
forth are shielded.
(3) System ground system
The system ground system is designed to connect the frame ground
system (FG) provided between equipment and units to ground.
Distribution board
171
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
2.15.3
Signal Ground (SG)
Connection of Control
Unit
M4 stud
Ground cable
Wire of 2 mm2 or more
Connect the 0 V line inside the control unit to the ground plate of the
cabinet through the signal ground (SG) terminal (shown above).
172
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
R C
Equivalent circuit of spark killer
Spark killer
AC relay
Motor
Spark killer
NOTE
Use a CR–type noise suppressor. A varistor has a function
for clamping the peak voltage of a pulse voltage, but cannot
suppress a spike–like voltage.
173
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
2.15.5 According to the figure below, clamp all cables that require shielding and
Cable Clamping and are run to the CNC, servo amplifier, spindle amplifier, and so forth. This
clamping method not only secures cables, but also shields cables. Cable
Shielding clamping and shielding are a key to stable system operation. Always
perform cable clamping and shielding according to the method described
here.
As shown below, peel off a part of the outer sheath of each cable so that
the shield cover is exposed, then press and retain the exposed part of the
shield against the ground plate with a clamp.
Ground plate
Cable
Clamp
40mm∼80mm
174
B–63005EN/01 2. HARDWARE
ÇÇ
Mounting plate of the machine
ÇÇ
Control unit
ÇÇ
ÇÇ
ÇÇ
ÇÇ
ÇÇ
ÇÇ
ÇÇ
ÇÇ
ÇÇ
Ground plate
ÇÇ
ÇÇ
ÇÇ
ÇÇ
ÇÇ
Clamp
Shield cover
ÇÇ
Fig. 2.15.5(b) Cable clamp (2)
Ground terminal
(to be connected
to ground)
Mounting hole
For a ground plate, use an iron plate that is as thick as 2 mm or more and
is plated with nickel.
175
2. HARDWARE B–63005EN/01
Ground plate
8mm
12mm
20mm
55 mm maximum
28mm
6mm
17mm
176
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
After you change a SRAM module, you must set various data again.
This chapter describes the procedures to input and output the parameters,
the part programs and the tool offset values.
177
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
3.1
SETTING
PARAMETERS
FOR INPUT/OUTPUT
D Setting procedure of 1. Set to MDI mode or emergency stop state.
parameters
2. Press OFFSET
SETTING key several times or press soft key [SETING] to display
SETTING (HANDY) screen.
3. Set the cursor to PARAMETER WRITE and, press 1 and INPUT
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0012 RMV MIR
X 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Y 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Z 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
B 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0020 I/O CHANNEL
S 0 T0000
178
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
7. Convenient method
1) To change parameters in bit unit, press cursor key or ,
then the cursor becomes bit length and you can set parameters bit
by bit (Bit parameter only).
2) To set data consecutively, use EOB key.
9 9 9 INPUT
179
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
0101 NFD ASI SB2
180
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
1: 50 5: 200 9: 2400
2: 100 6: 300 l10: 4800
3: 110 7: 600 11: 9600
4: 150 8: 1200 12: 19200 [BPS]
4. Press SYSTEM key and soft key [PARAM] to display parameter screen.
181
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
3.2.3
Outputting PMC 1. Select MDI mode.
Parameters 2. Press OFFSET
SETTING key then soft key [SETTING] to select a setting screen.
15.Press soft key [EXEC]. Then PMC parameters are started to be output.
16.After the PMC parameters have been output, set PARAMETER
WRITE to 0.
17.Press RESET to release alarm 100.
3.2.4
Outputting Pitch Error 1. Select EDIT mode.
Compensation Amount 2. Press SYSTEM key several times, press soft key [PARAM], and
[PITCH] to select the SETTING screen for pitch error amount.
3. Press soft key [(OPRT)] and .
4. Press soft key [PUNCH] and [EXEC], then pitch error compensation
amount is started to be output.
182
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
3.2.5 When custom macro function is equipped, values of variable no. 500 and
Outputting Custom later are output.
Macro Variable Values 1. Press OFFSET
SETTING key.
3.2.6
Outputting Tool 1. Select EDIT mode.
Compensation Amount
2. Press OFFSET
SETTING key and soft key [OFFSET] to display the tool
compensation amount screen.
3. Press [(OPRT)] key and soft key .
4. Press soft key [PUNCH] an [EXEC] key, and the tool compensation
amount is started to be output.
3.2.7
Outputting Part Program 1. Confirm the following parameters. If 1 is set, set to the MDI mode and
set it to 0.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3202 NE9 NE8
183
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
3.2.8
Inputting CNC 1. Set to the emergency stop state.
Parameters 2. Confirm that the patameters required to input data is correct.
1) Press OFFSET/SETTING key several times, and press [SETING]
to display SETTING screen.
2) Confirm that PARAMETER WRITE=1.
3) Press SYSTEM key to select the parameter screen.
4)
0020 Selectionof I/O channel
5)
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
0101 NFD ASI SB2
6)
0102 Specification number of I/O device
184
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
7)
0103 Baud rate
1: 50 5: 200 9: 2400
2: 100 6: 300 l10: 4800
3: 110 7: 600 11: 9600
4: 150 8: 1200 12: 19200 [BPS]
3. Press soft key [(OPRT)] and soft key
4. Press soft key [READ] and [EXEC]. Then input of parameters are
started.
5. Because alarm 300 will generate for the system with absolute pulse
coder, set parameter 1815#5 to 0.
6. Alarm 300 is issued if the system employs an absolute pulse coder.
In such a case, perform reference position return again.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
1815 APCx
7. After the parameters have been input, turn off the power once then turn
it on.
185
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
3.2.11 If the system is equipped with the custom macro fucntion, input the
Inputting Custom Macro variable values.
For PPR, item 4 is not required.
Variable Values
1. Confirm that EDIT mode is selected.
2. Turn off the program protect key (KEY2=1).
3. Press PROG key then soft key [PRGRM] to display program contents.
8. Press OFFSET
SETTING key, key and soft key [MACRO] to select the custom
macro variable screen.
9. Press 500 and soft key [NO SRH] to display variable number 500 and
confirm the custom macro variables are set correctly.
Of the data displayed, 0 and vacant differ in meaning.
Vacant is an undefined variable. To set vacant, press soft key
[INPUT].
10.Select EDIT mode again.
11.Press PROG key to select the program display screen.
186
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
12.Press address O and a program number (0001 for example) ,then press
DELETE to delete the program.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3201 NPE RAL
#6 (NPE) When programs are registered in part program storage area, M02,M30
and M99 are:
0 : regarded as the end of program.
l 1 : not regarded as the end of porgram.
#1 (RAL) When programs are registered:
l 0 : All programs are registered.
1 : Only one program is registered.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3202 NE9 NE8
#4 (NE9)
l 0 : Programs of 9000s can be edited.
1 : Programs of 9000s are protected.
#0 (NE8)
l 0 : Programs of 8000s can be edited.
1 : Programs of 8000s are protected.
For PPR, item 4 is not required.
187
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
188
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
3.3
INPUT/OUTPUT
SUPER CAP DATA
3.3.1 The following operation allows all the data used for Super CAP M to be
Input/Output of input and output in a lump.
Conversational Data in a
1. Confirm the parameters shown below:
Lump(Super CAP M)
P0020: I/O CHANNEL (select I/O device) : 0
P0102: I/O device number : 3
P0103: Baud rate for 4800 bauds : 10
for 9600 bauds : 11
2. Select EDIT mode.
3. Press function key PROG and press soft key [CAP].
4. Press soft key [8] (C.A.P DATA) on the basic menu screen.Serial 16i
Conversational Data Screen
C.A.P. DATA
189
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
DATA I/O
OR
The above operation reads and punches default data, pre–tool list, tool file
and F.S. file in a lump.
190
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
CAUTION
You should input/output NC parameters separately. You
can input/output other data in a lump.
191
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
SINGLE SINGLE
CAUTION
For one–path control CNC, data select menu on tool post 2
is not displayed.
192
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
< +
NC NC NC PMC CAP CAP- NC HD2 NC HD2 NC HD2 SELECT
PARAM OFFSET PROG PARAM TOOL PROG PARAM OFFSET PROG END
NOTE
For one–path control CNC, the following soft keys are
displayed.
< +
NC NC NC PMC CAP CAP- I/O
PRE–PG SELECT
PARAM OFFSET PROG PARAM TOOL PROG SET UP END
CAUTION
NC parameters can be output only separately. If NC
parameters are selected to be output with other data, other
data is canceled.
193
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
[ALL SELECT] Press this key to output all the programs.When you
press this key, the following menu is displayed.
<
EXEC CANCEL
To execute punching all the programs, press [EXEC] and when it is not
needed, press [CANCEL].
[ALL CANCEL] Press this key to cancel outputting all the data.
When this key is pressed, the same soft key as
when [ALL SELECT] is pressed is displayed.
To execute cancelling, press [EXEC]; to cancel
cancelling, press [CANCEL].
[SELECT] When you specify a NC program to be punched,
move the cursor to the program number and
press this key.
[CANCEL] To cancel outputting NC programs, press this
key.
[SELECT END] When you finsh specification of punching, press
this key.
194
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
PUNCH
SINGLE SINGLE
1. NC PARAMETER (HD1) 7. NC PARAMETER (HD2)
NOTE
1 The data format output by the above funciton is different
from the data format input/output in an individual operation.
Therefore, output data by this function cannot be used for
inputting.
2 Data format is different between 1–path and 2–path for
two–path control.
3 The data that can be input by the input/output in a lump
function is limited to data output by the same function.
4 The range of PMC parameters to be output can be specified
by the following NC parameter.
NC parameter
9090 PMCIOS
PMCIOS
: The start address number of D area of the PMC parameters to be output.
9091 PMCIOE
PMCIOE
: The end address number of D area of PMC parameters to be output.
No.9090(PMCIOS)=0, No.9091(PMCIOE)=0
: All the PMC parameters including keep relays, counters, timers and data
are output.
No.9090(PMCIOS)=No.9091(PMCIOE) : 0
: D area data (one data) of the specified address number is output.
No.9090(PMCIOS) < No.9091(PMCIOE)
: D area data of PMC parameters from the specified starting address
number to the ending address number are output.
No.9090(PMCIOS) > No.9091(PMCIOE)
: All the data in D area are output.
195
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
Input of conversational Data output by using the function for inputting/outputting data in a lump
data in a lump can also be input by using that function.
1. Set optional parameters and the parameter for specifying the number
of axes (parameter No. 1010) manually before reading NC parameters.
2. In the same way as output operation, connect an external I/O device
and set necessary parameters, such as device selection.
3. Select EDIT mode. For a two–path system, select the screen for tool
post 1.
4. Release protection for each data item to be input.
1) NC parameter: Set ”PARAMETER WRITE” in the setting data
to 1.
2) Offset: Turn off offset data protection (KEY1 = 1).
3) NC program: Turn off program protection (KEY3 = 1).
4) PMC parameter: Set ”PARAMETER WRITE” in the setting
data to 1.
5) Tool file: Turn off offset data protection (KEY1 = 1).
6) Conversational program: Turn off program protection (KEY3 = 1).
5. Display the data input/output menu screen.
6. Press [READ] to display the following screen.
READ
SINGLE SINGLE
1. NC PARAMETER(HD1) 7. NC PARAMETER(HD2)
< NC OTH-
NC HD2 I/O PRE– EXE
PARAM
PARAM PARAM PG C
ERS
CAUTION
1 For a single–path system, the data selection menu for tool
post 2 is not displayed.
2 When the I/O device is other than the FANUC cassette
adapter, soft keys [NC PARAM], [OTHERS], and [NC HD2
PARAM] are not displayed.
7. Make preparations for the data to be read (including a search for the
beginning of the data) when an I/O device other than the FANUC
cassette adapter is used.
When the FANUC cassette adapter is used, the data can be retrieved
automatically, such that no preparation is required.
196
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
10.Press [EXEC] to start data input or press [CAN] to cancel data input.
For data other than NC parameters, if multiple data items have been
output at a time, they can also be input at a time.
During data input, ”INPUTTING” blinks on the lower–right corner
of the screen. The data being input is displayed by blinks of yellow
characters in reverse video. When data input terminates normally, it
is indicated by blue characters; if data input terminates with an error,
the data is indicated by red characters.
197
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
NOTE
Only a machining program created with the conversational
input function can be output by applying the above
procedure.
A machining program created using the NC program screen
cannot be output by applying the above procedure.
198
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
Input of conversational The machining program punched out by applying the procedure described
machining programs on the previous page can be read into the NC via a reader/punch interface.
Before attempting to read a program, release the memory protect switch
on the machine operator’s panel.
After switching to EDIT mode, display the registered program list screen
for editing, then press [READ]. The following message prompting the
user to input the file number is displayed, as well as the soft keys used to
confirm operation.
Enter the number of the file containing the machining program to be input,
using numeric keys, then press [EXEC]. Reading of the machining
program starts. When the input device is FANUC PPR, press [EXEC]
without inputting a file number.
When [CAN] is pressed, read operation is canceled and the previous state
is restored.
Upon the start of inputting machining programs, ”INPUTTING” blinks
at the bottom of the screen, until the input operation ends.
NOTE
Only a machining program created with the conversational
input function can be input by applying the above
procedure.
A machining program created using the NC program screen
cannot be input by applying the above procedure.
199
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
Output of conversational The tool data file, cutting condition data, surface roughness data, pre–tool
tool setting data list, and chuck/tailstock figure data can be punched out to an external I/O
device.
(1) Connect an external I/O device and set necessary parameters, such as
device selection.
(2) Select EDIT mode.
(3) Display the tool data menu screen, then press [+]. The following soft
keys appear. Press [PUNCH].
*** F.100–1 ***
< 10 11 READ PUN CLEA \
CH R
Input of conversational The setting data punched out in the previous section can be read.
tool setting data (1) Connect an external I/O device and set necessary parameters, such as
device selection.
(2) Set ”PARAMETER WRITE” in the setting data to 1.
(3) When the FANUC cassette adapter is used, set the file number for
parameter No. 9887 (TLFLNO).
(4) Display the tool data menu screen and place the system in the
emergency stop state.
(5) Press [READ].
Clearing of The tool data file, cutting condition data, surface roughness data, pre–tool
conversational tool list, and chuck/tailstock figure data can be cleared.
setting data (1) Set ”PARAMETER WRITE” in the setting data to 1.
(2) Display the tool data menu screen. After switching to EDIT mode,
place the system in the emergency stop state.
(3) Press [CLEAR].
200
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
INPUTTING/ Symbolic
OUTPUTTING CAP–II FAPT TURN
DATA (16i–T)
4 or 5 INPUT 1 INPUT
(REFER TO TABLE 3)
201
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
202
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
3.5 The sub memory is stored in RAM module on the Option 3 board (board
for CAP–II). The procedure below describes a method to input and output
DUMP/RESTORE OF the data in sub memory, which is used when Option 3 board or RAM
CAP–II DATA (16i–T) module is replaced.
3.5.1
Kind of Data in Sub 1. System parameter (FAPT–SYS. PARAM.)
Memory 2. MTF (FAPT–MTF)
3. Setting data (FAPT–SETTING)
4. Tool data Turning tool (FAPT–TOOL)
C axis tool
5. Graphic data (FAPT–GRAPHIC)
6. Files Family program (FAPT–FAMILY)
Material file (FAPT–MATERIAL)
Sub cycle file (FAPT–SUB. CYCLE)
7. Initial screen registration command data
3.5.2
Operation
D Outputting data (Dump)
1. Display the screen of Symbolic FAPT TURN.
2. To output data on FANUC Cassette, press keys as follows:
[AUXILIARY]⇒ D U M P , B INPUT
203
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
3.6
CLEARING CAP–II
DATA (16i–T)
3.6.1
Deleting File Name and
Symbolic FAPT TURN
Files (Initial screen)
No
Delete a file ?
Yes
DEL
INPUT
EOB ,
1 , INPUT 0 , INPUT
204
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
205
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
206
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
NOTE
1 If program or floppy is selected in EDIT mode, the program
directory or floppy screen is displayed.
2 When the power is first turned on, program is selected by
default.
NOTE
Baud rate clock, CD check (232C), reset/alarm report, and
the parity bit for parameter No. 134, as well as the
communication code, end code, communication protocol,
interface, and SAT command for parameter No. 135 are
displayed only when channel 3 is being used for
input/output.
4 Select the soft key corresponding to the desired type of data (program,
parameter, and so forth).
207
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
3.7.2 A program can be input and output using the ALL IO screen.
Inputting and When entering a program using a cassette or card, the user must specify
the input file containing the program (file search).
Outputting Programs
File search
1 Press soft key [PRGRM] on the ALL IO screen, described in Section
3.7.1.
2 Select EDIT mode. A program directory is displayed.
3 Press soft key [(OPRT)]. The screen and soft keys change as shown
below.
⋅ A program directory is displayed only in EDIT mode. In all other
modes, the ALL IO screen is displayed.
O0001 N00010
EDIT * * * * *** *** *** 14:46:09
F SRH READ PUNCH DELETE (OPRT)
4 Enter address N.
5 Enter the number of the file to be found.
⋅ N0
The first floppy file is found.
⋅ One of N1 to N9999
Among the files numbered from 1 to 9999, a specified file is found.
⋅ N–9999
The file immediately after that used most recently is found.
⋅ N–9998
When –9998 is specified, the next file is found. Then, each time
a file input/output operation is performed, N–9999 is automatically
inserted. This means that subsequent files can be sequentially
found automatically.
208
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
Inputting a program
1 Press soft key [PRGRM] on the ALL IO screen, described in Section
3.7.1.
2 Select EDIT mode. A program directory is displayed.
3 Press soft key [(OPRT)]. The screen and soft keys change as shown
below.
⋅ A program directory is displayed only in EDIT mode. In all other
modes, the ALL IO screen is displayed.
O0001 N00010
EDIT * * * * *** *** *** 14:46:09
F SRH READ PUNCH DELETE (OPRT)
209
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
Outputting programs
1 Press soft key [PRGRM] on the ALL IO screen, described in Section
3.7.1.
2 Select EDIT mode. A program directory is displayed.
3 Press soft key [(OPRT)]. The screen and soft keys change as shown
below.
⋅ A program directory is displayed only in EDIT mode. In all other
modes, the ALL IO screen is displayed.
O0001 N00010
EDIT * * * * *** *** *** 14:46:09
F SRH READ PUNCH DELETE (OPRT)
4 Enter address O.
5 Enter a desired program number.
If –9999 is entered, all programs in memory are output.
To output a range of programs, enter O∆∆∆∆, OVVVV.. The
programs numbered from ∆∆∆∆ to VVVV are output.
When bit 4 (SOR) of parameter No. 3107 for sorted display is set to 1
on the program library screen, programs are output in order, starting
from those having the smallest program numbers.
6 Press soft key [PUNCH], then [EXEC].
STOP CAN EXEC
The specified program or programs are output. If steps 4 and 5 are
omitted, the currently selected program is output.
To cancel output, press soft key [CAN].
To stop output prior to its completion, press soft key [STOP].
210
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
Deleting files
1 Press soft key [PRGRM] on the ALL IO screen, described in Section
3.7.1.
2 Select EDIT mode. A program directory is displayed.
3 Press soft key [(OPRT)]. The screen and soft keys change as shown
below.
⋅ A program directory is displayed only in EDIT mode. In all other
modes, the ALL IO screen is displayed.
O0001 N00010
EDIT * * * * *** *** *** 14:46:09
F SRH READ PUNCH DELETE (OPRT)
211
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
3.7.3 Parameters can be input and output using the ALL IO screen.
Inputting and
Outputting Parameters
Inputting parameters
1 Press soft key [PARAM] on the ALL IO screen, described in Section
3.7.1.
2 Select EDIT mode.
3 Press soft key [(OPRT)]. Soft keys change as shown below.
READ PUNCH
Outputting parameters
1 Press soft key [PARAM] on the ALL IO screen, described in Section
3.7.1.
2 Select EDIT mode.
3 Press soft key [(OPRT)]. Soft keys change as shown below.
READ PUNCH
212
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
3.7.4 Offset data can be input and output using the ALL IO screen.
Inputting and
Outputting Offset Data
1 Press soft key [OFFSET] on the ALL IO screen, described in Section
3.7.1.
2 Select EDIT mode.
3 Press soft key [(OPRT)]. Soft keys change as shown below.
READ PUNCH
1 Press soft key [OFFSET] on the ALL IO screen, described in Section
3.7.1.
2 Select EDIT mode.
3 Press soft key [(OPRT)]. Soft keys change as shown below.
READ PUNCH
213
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
3.7.5 Custom macro common variables can be output using the ALL IO screen.
Outputting Custom
Macro Common
Variables
1 Press soft key [MACRO] on the ALL IO screen, described in Section
3.7.1.
2 Select EDIT mode.
3 Press soft key [(OPRT)]. Soft keys change as shown below.
READ PUNCH
NOTE
To input a macro variable, read the desired custom macro
statement as a program, then execute the program.
214
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
3.7.6 The ALL IO screen supports the display of a directory of floppy files, as
Inputting and well as the input and output of floppy files.
Outputting Floppy
Files
1 Press the rightmost soft key (continuous menu key) on the ALL
IO screen, described in Section 3.7.1.
2 Press soft key [FLOPPY].
3 Select EDIT mode. The floppy screen is displayed.
4 Press soft key [(OPRT)]. The screen and soft keys change as shown
below.
⋅ The floppy screen is displayed only in EDIT mode. In all other
modes, the ALL IO screen is displayed.
>
MDI **** *** *** *** 12:34:56
F SRH READ PUNCH DELETE
215
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
216
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
Inputting a file
1 Press the rightmost soft key (continuous menu key) on the ALL
IO screen, described in Section 3.7.1.
2 Press soft key [FLOPPY].
3 Select EDIT mode. The floppy screen is displayed.
4 Press soft key [(OPRT)]. The screen and soft keys change as shown
below.
The floppy screen is displayed only in EDIT mode. In all other
modes, the ALL IO screen is displayed.
>
MDI **** *** *** *** 12:34:56
F SRH READ PUNCH DELETE
217
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
Outputting a file
1 Press the rightmost soft key (continuous menu key) on the ALL
IO screen, described in Section 3.7.1.
2 Press soft key [FLOPPY].
3 Select EDIT mode. The floppy screen is displayed.
4 Press soft key [(OPRT)]. The screen and soft keys change as shown
below.
The floppy screen is displayed only in EDIT mode. In all other
modes, the ALL IO screen is displayed.
>
MDI **** *** *** *** 12:34:56
F SRH READ PUNCH DELETE
218
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
Deleting a file
1 Press the rightmost soft key (continuous menu key) on the ALL
IO screen, described in Section 3.7.1.
2 Press soft key [FLOPPY].
3 Select EDIT mode. The floppy screen is displayed.
4 Press soft key [(OPRT)]. The screen and soft keys change as shown
below.
The floppy screen is displayed only in EDIT mode. In all other
modes, the ALL IO screen is displayed.
>
MDI **** *** *** *** 12:34:56
F SRH READ PUNCH DELETE
219
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
3.7.7 Data held in CNC memory can be saved to a memory card in MS–DOS
Memory Card format. Data held on a memory card can be loaded into CNC memory.
A save or load operation can be performed using soft keys while the CNC
Input/Output is operating.
Loading can be performed in either of two ways. In the first method, all
saved memory data is loaded. In the second method, only selected data
is loaded.
File ( 1/ 1)
SRAM0_5A. FDB 524288 byte 97/ 01/ 23 *3 : Names, sizes, dates, and number of
files recorded on the memory card
Message
COMPLETED. *4 : Operation message
TURN OFF POWER.
220
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
Saving memory data Data held in CNC memory can be saved to a memory card in MS–DOS
format.
1 Press the rightmost soft key (continuous menu key) on the ALL
IO screen, described in Section 3.7.1.
2 Press soft key [M–CARD].
3 Place the CNC in the emergency stop state.
4 When a memory card is inserted, the state of the memory card is
displayed as shown below.
File ( 1/ 1)
SRAM0_5A. FDB 524288 byte 97/ 01/ 23
Message
NOTE
All CNC memory data is saved to a memory card. CNC
memory data cannot be saved selectively.
221
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
Loading Data into CNC memory data that has been saved to a memory card can be loaded
Memory (Restoration) (restored) back into CNC memory.
CNC memory data can be loaded in either of two ways. In the first
method, all saved memory data is loaded. In the second method, only
selected data is loaded.
1 Press the rightmost soft key (continuous menu key) on the ALL
IO screen, described in Section 3.7.1.
2 Press soft key [M–CARD].
3 Place the CNC in the emergency stop state.
4 When a memory card is inserted, the state of the memory card is
displayed as shown below.
File ( 1/ 1)
SRAM0_5A. FDB 524288 byte 97/ 01/ 23
Message
6 With cursor keys and , select the file to be loaded from the
memory card.
A system having 1.0MB or 2.5MB of CNC RAM may require the
loading of multiple files. All or selective data load can be specified
for each file.
7 To perform selective data loading, press soft key [SELECT], then
SELECT CAN EXEC
select the data to be loaded. Each time the soft key is pressed, the
information displayed changes cyclically, as shown below.
C Macro data
222
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
Memory card formatting Before a file can be saved to a memory card, the memory card must be
formatted.
1 Press the rightmost soft key (continuous menu key) on the ALL
IO screen, described in Section 3.7.1.
2 Press soft key [M–CARD].
3 Place the CNC in the emergency stop state.
4 When a memory card is inserted, the state of the memory card is
displayed as shown below.
File ( 1/ 1)
SRAM0_5A. FDB 524288 byte 97/ 01/ 23
Message
223
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
Deleting files Unnecessary saved files can be deleted from a memory card.
Deleting files
1 Press the rightmost soft key (continuous menu key) on the ALL
IO screen, described in Section 3.7.1.
2 Press soft key [M–CARD].
3 Place the CNC in the emergency stop state.
4 When a memory card is inserted, the state of the memory card is
displayed as shown below.
File ( 1/ 1)
SRAM0_5A. FDB 524288 byte 97/ 01/ 23
Message
CAN EXEC
6 With cursor keys and , select the file to be deleted from the
memory card.
7 After checking the file selection, press soft key [EXEC].
8 As detection is being performed, the message ”DELETING” blinks in
the message field.
9 Upon the completion of deletion, the message ”COMPLETED” is
displayed in the message field
NOTE
An SRAM of 1M bytes or more will contain multiple files. To
delete the contents of such an SRAM, delete all the
contained files.
224
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
Messages
Message Description
INSERT MEMORY CARD. No memory card is inserted.
UNUSABLE MEMORY CARD The memory card does not contain device information.
FORMAT MEMORY CARD. The memory card is not formatted. Format the memory card before use.
THE FILE IS UNUSABLE. The format or extension of the file to be loaded is invalid. Alternatively, the
data stored on the memory card does not match the CNC memory size.
REPLACE MEMORY CARD. Replace the memory card.
FILE SYSTEM ERROR VVV An error occurred during file system processing. VVV represents a file
system error code.
SET EMERGENCY STOP STATE. Save/load operation is enabled in the emergency stop state only.
WRITE–PROTECTED Save operation: The protect switch of the memory card is set to the
disabled position.
Load operation: Parameter write is disabled.
VOLTAGE DECREASED. The battery voltage of the memory card has dropped. (The battery
requires replacement.)
DEVICE IS BUSY. Another user is using the memory card. Alternatively, the device cannot
be accessed because automatic operation is in progress.
SRAM ³ MEMORY CARD? This message prompts the user to confirm the start of data saving.
MEMORY CARD ³ SRAM? This message prompts the user to confirm the start of data loading.
DO YOU WANT TO DELETE FILE(S)? This message prompts the user to confirm the start of deletion.
DO YOU WANT TO PERFORM FORMAT- This message prompts the user to confirm the start of formatting.
TING?
SAVING Saving is currently being performed.
LOADING Loading is currently being performed.
DELETING File deletion is currently being performed.
FORMATTING Memory card formatting is currently being performed.
225
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
Message Description
COMPLETED Save or load processing has been completed.
PRESS RESET KEY. Press the RESET key.
TURN OFF POWER. Turn the power off, then back on again.
226
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
3.8 By setting the I/O channel (parameter No. 20) to 4, files on a memory card
can be referenced, and different types of data such as part programs,
DATA INPUT/OUTPUT parameters, and offset data on a memory card can be input and output in
USING A MEMORY text file format.
CARD The major functions are listed below.
⋅ Displaying a directory of stored files
The files stored on a memory card can be displayed on the directory
screen.
⋅ Searching for a file
A search is made for a file on a memory card and, if found, it is
displayed on the directory screen.
⋅ Reading a file
Text–format files can be read from a memory card.
⋅ Writing a file
Data such as part programs can be stored to a memory card in text file
format.
⋅ Deleting a file
A file can be selected and deleted from a memory card.
Writing a file
Reading a file
Deleting a file
227
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
4 Press soft key [CARD]. The screen shown below is displayed. Using
page keys and , the screen can be scrolled.
~ ~
PROG DIR + (OPRT)
~ ~
PROG DIR + (OPRT)
6 Repeatedly pressing soft key [DIR+] toggles the screen between the
display of comments and the display of sizes and dates.
Any comment described after the O number in the file is displayed.
Up to 18 characters can be displayed on the screen.
228
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
~ ~
PROG DIR + (OPRT)
229
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
Reading a file
~ ~
PROG DIR + (OPRT)
6 To specify a file number, press soft key [F READ]. The screen shown
below is displayed.
~ ~
READ
FILE NAME=20 PROGRAM No.=120
>
EDIT * * * **** *** **** 15:40:21
7 Enter file number 20 from the MDI panel, then set the file number by
pressing soft key [F SET]. Next, enter program number 120, then set
the program number by pressing soft key [O SET]. Then, press soft
key [EXEC].
⋅ File number 20 is registered as O0120 in the CNC.
⋅ Set a program number to register a read file with a separate O
number. If no program number is set, the O number in the file name
column is registered.
230
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
8 To specify a file with its file name, press soft key [N READ] in step 6
above. The screen shown below is displayed.
~ ~
READ FILE NAME =TESTPRO
PROGRAM No. =1230
>
EDIT * * * **** *** **** 15:40:21
231
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
Writing a file
~ ~
PROG DIR + (OPRT)
8 In the same way as for O number setting, enter a desired file name
from the MDI panel, then set the file name with soft key [F SET].
When soft key [EXEC] is pressed after the setting shown below has
been made, for example, the file is written under program number
O1230 and file name ABCD12.
~ ~
PUNCH FILE NAME =ABCD12
PROGRAM No. =1230
>
EDIT * * * **** *** **** 15:40:21
F NAME O SET STOP CAN EXEC
232
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
Deleting a file
~ ~
PROG DIR + (OPRT)
233
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
5 With cursor keys and , the user can choose between upper
part scrolling and lower part scrolling. (An asterisk (*) displayed at
the left edge indicates the part for which scrolling is possible.)
234
B–63005EN/01 3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA
M–CARD (OPRT)
When a data item other than program is selected, the screen displays only
a file directory.
A data item is indicated, in parentheses, on the title line.
~ ~
NOTE
With a memory card, RMT mode operation and the
subprogram call function (based on the M198 command)
cannot be used.
235
3. INPUT AND OUTPUT OF DATA B–63005EN/01
Error codes
236
B–63005EN/01 4.INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC
This chapter describes the signals between the machine operator’s panel,
magnetics cabinet and the PMC, connection of the signals between PMC
and CNC, and confirmation method of on/off state of these signals.
It also describes system configuration of PMC, parameters of PMC,
ladder and how to display time chart of the signals on the screen.
It also describes a method of inputting/outputting PMC parameters to an
external device.
237
4.1
0V
+24E
X5.7
Power
STL STL supply
238
F Y
–
PMCDGN PMCDGN *
0V 0V
F 0000 ~ 0141 Y 0000 ~ 0127
4.2
SPECIFICATION OF
PMC
4.2.1
Specification
Series 16i–MODEL A/Series 18i–MODEL A
Model
PMC–RB5 PMC–RB6
Programming method language Ladder Ladder
C–language Step sequence
C–language
Number of ladder level 2 2
Level–1 Cycle Time 8 ms 8 ms
Basic Instruction Execution Time 0.085 0.085
(us/step) (us/step)
Program capacity
D Ladder (step) Approx. 3,000 Approx. 3,000
Approx. 5,000 Approx. 5,000
Approx. 8,000 Approx. 8,000
Approx. 12,000 Approx. 12,000
Approx. 16,000 Approx. 16,000
Approx. 24,000 Approx. 24,000
D Symbol/Comment Approx. 32,000
239
4. INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC B–63005EN/01
4.2.2
Address
Model
Series 16i–MODEL
Character Signal description
4/Series 18i–MODEL
PMC–RB5 PMC–RB6
X0 to X127
Input signal from the machine to
X X1000 to X1019
the PMC (MT to PMC)
X1020 to 1039
Y0 to Y127
Output signal from the PMC to the
Y Y1000 to Y1014
machine (PMC to MT)
Y1020 to Y1034
240
B–63005EN/01 4.INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC
4.2.3
Built–in Debug Function Contents
Function
Display of sequence program Dynamic display of ladder diagram
4.2.4 (1) R9000 (Operation output register for the ADD, SUB, MULB, DIVB,
System Reserve Area and COMPB functional instructions)
of Internal Relay #7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
Zero
Sign is minus
Overflow
(2) R9000 (Error output for the EXIN, WINDR, WINDW, MMCWR,
MMCWW, MMC3R, and MMC3W functional instructions)
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
R9000
The instruc-
tion ended in
error.
241
4. INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC B–63005EN/01
(3) R9002 to R9005 (Operation output registers for the DIVB functional
instruction)
The data remaining after the DIVB functional instruction is executed
in output.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
R9002
R9003
Register for
remainder
R9004 (used by DIVB
instruction)
R9005
(4) R9100 to R9117 (Interface area for the FNC9x functional instruction)
The area is provided as an interface between the FNC9x functional
instruction to be executed and a desired function.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
Contents of the com-
R9100 97 96 95 94 93 92 91 90 mand to be executed
R9104
Addresses of the control data for SUB91
R9105
R9116
Addresses of the control data for SUB97
R9117
242
B–63005EN/01 4.INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
R9091
always OFF
always ON
Cyclic signal of 200
ms (104 ms ON, 96
ms OFF)
CAUTION
Each signal is initially off. R9091.0 and R9091.1 are set
cyclically at the beginning of the first ladder level.
Each signal (ON–OFF signal) has an accuracy of "8 ms.
R9091.5
104ms 96ms
200ms
R9091.6
504ms 496ms
1s
243
4. INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC B–63005EN/01
4.2.5
Execution Period of
PMC
Sequence program
1st level
From NC (High–speed se-
(1) quence)
END1
2nd level
(Normal sequence)
(2)–1
Synchronized
buffer
(2)–2
Period
(1) (1) (1) (1)
1st level
(2)–1 (2)–2 (2)–n (2)–1
2nd level
3rd level
244
B–63005EN/01 4.INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC
4.3
PMC SCREEN
RUN/STOP f f f
EDIT × f f
I/O f f f
SYSPRM × f f
245
4. INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC B–63005EN/01
X008.4 *ESP
EMERGENCY
STOP
END1
PORD POR
POWER ON
RESET
246
B–63005EN/01 4.INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC
[Remarks]
⋅ The search function searches a signal in the forward direction and
displays the ladder with the searched signal at its head. Because there
may exist plural contacts, repeat the search operation to find plural
locations, repeat the search operation to find plural locations with the
specified signal.
⋅ If a specified signal is not found up to the end of the program (ladder),
execution returns to the head of a program and search continues.
D Dump display on ladder Ladder diagram and signal status dump can displayed together.
diagram The dump is displayed over 2 lines at the last line of ladder diagram by
pressing the [DUMP] soft key.
PAGE
PAGE
keys or [SEARCH] soft key is used for changing of PMC
address.
247
4. INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC B–63005EN/01
D Display of setting trigger The setting address, condition and counter are displayed at the title line.
“MODE:ON : X0000. 0 : 0 : 0001 ”
NOTE
“;”=”EOB” adr (trigger address) ;p1 (trigger point) ;p2 (trigger
checking number (1~65535))
* Because parameters are stored in the nonvolatile memory, they are not
lost even if the power is turned off.
When bit 2 of keep relay K18 is set to 1 after parameters for sampling
are specified, the trigger function automatically starts when the power
is turned on.
For this operation, depress [TRIGER] soft key to bring the following
menu.
SEARCH ADRESS TRIGER WINDOW
RET
NEXT
248
B–63005EN/01 4.INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC
D Divided display of ladder This function is used for displaying the divided screen. It can display
diagram max. six division.
For this operation, depress [WINDOW] soft key to bring the following
menu.
SEARCH ADRESS TRIGER WINDOW
RET
When the ladder program is executing, a part of the ladder program can
be changed.
S Change the type of contact (A contact, B contact)
S Change address of contact and coil.
S Change address parameter of functional instruction.
This function don’t change the size.
(Cannot be Addition, deletion and chanegable data size)
When bit 3 in the keep relay K18 is 1, this program is automatically
transferred to backup RAM after on–line edit.
When bit 3 in the keep relay K18 is 0, transfer to backup RAM with COPY
function of I/O screen. If power is off without this operation, edited data
is lost.
249
4. INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC B–63005EN/01
4.3.3 Press soft key [PMCDGN] then PMC’s diagnostic screen is displayed.
PMCDGN Screen
D TITLE screen The title data registered when a ladder program is prepared is displayed.
Page number
M.SRCH ANALYS
ÄÄÄ
ÄÄ
ÄÄÄ
1st page PMC PROGRAM NO. : Set when PMC
ÄÄ ÄÄ
ÄÄ
EDITION NO. : is
prepared
ÄÄ ÄÄ
ÄÄ
PMC CONTROL PROGRAM
SERIES : EDITION : Series and edition of PMC
control software
MEMORY USED : KB
LADDER
SYMBOL
MESSAGE
SCAN TIME
ÄÄ
ÄÄ
:
:
:
:
KB
KB
KB
MSEC
Memory used and
execution time is
displayed.
250
B–63005EN/01 4.INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC
D STATUS screen On/Off state of input/output signals and internal relay is displayed.
SEARCH
[Search Method]
• Page key :Forward and Backward by screen
• Cursor key :Forward and Backward by diagnostic number
• To search a specified address or signal name, input an address number
or signal name and press [SEARCH].
ALM Blinked
251
4. INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC B–63005EN/01
D TRACE screen Every time a specified signal changes, the signal status is memorized in
the trace memory. This function is useful for identifying intermittent
troubles.
1 Trace parameter screen
T.DISP EXEC
252
B–63005EN/01 4.INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC
ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ
0001 * * * * * * * *
0002 I I * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ
0003 * I * * * * * * * * * * * * * * Latest status
0004 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . I mark : 1
0005 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . * mark : 0
0006 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
0007 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
0008 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
TRCPRM STOP
10″LCD/14″CRT is dis-
played by 1 and 0.
ÀÀÀÀ
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
ÀÀÀÀ
K017
253
4. INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC B–63005EN/01
4.3.4
Memory Display
(M.SRCH)
100000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 ................
100010 4142 4344 4546 4748 494A 4B4C 4D4E 4F50 ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOP
100020 2020 2020 2020 2020 2020 2020 2020 2020
100030 5152 5354 5556 5758 595A 2020 2020 2020 QRSTUVWXYZ
100040 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 ................
100050 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 ................
100060 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 ................
100070 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 ................
100080 4641 4E55 4320 434F 2E2C 5444 0000 0000 FANUC CO.LTD....
100090 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 ................
1000A0 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 ................
1000B0 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 ................
1000C0 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 ................
1000D0 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 ................
1000E0 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 ................
1000F0 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 ................
SEARCH INPUT
254
B–63005EN/01 4.INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC
D ANALYS screen Change of signals is displayed as the same display as that on the
(Ladder editing card is oscilloscope.
required for PMC–RB5/ 1 Parameter setting screen (1st page)
RB6)
CONDITION : 0
(0: START 1: TRIGGER–ON 2: TRIGGER–OFF)
255
4. INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC B–63005EN/01
SIGNAL ADDRESS
1 : X0000.0 9: Y0000.0
2 : X0000.1 10 : R0000.1
3 : X0002.0 11 :
Up to 16
4 : X0005.0 12 : signals
5 : 13 :
6 : 14 :
7 : 15 :
8 : 16 :
256
B–63005EN/01 4.INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC
3 SCOPE screen
257
4. INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC B–63005EN/01
4.3.5
D Inputting PMC
parameters from the MDI 1 Set to MDI mode or emergency stop state.
2 Set PARAMETER WRITE (on setting screen) to 1 or set the program
protect signal (KEY4) to 1.
PWE KEY4
Timer f –
Counter f f Either one
Keep relay f –
Data table f f Either one
Timer set time : Timer no. 1–8 is max. 1572.8 sec and its accuracy is
48ms.
Timer no. 9 is max. 262.1 sec and its accuracy is 8ms.
258
B–63005EN/01 4.INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC
D COUNTER screen This screen sets and displays max. value of counter and current value of
the counter instruction (SUB 4).
ÀÀÀÀ
00000000
ÀÀÀÀ
08 K07 00000000 18 K17 00000000
09 K08 00000000 19 K18 00000000
10 K09
TIMER COUNTR
00000000
KEEPRL
20 K19
DATA
ÀÀÀÀ
00000000
ÀÀ
ÀÀ
Address specified by ladder Used by PMC system
259
4. INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC B–63005EN/01
ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
K017
ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ
#7(DTBLDSP) 0 : The PMC parameter data table control screen is displayed.
1 : The PMC parameter data table control screen is not displayed.
#6(ANASTAT) 0 : Pressing [EXEC] key initiates sampling by signal waveform display
function.
1 : Turning power to on initiates sampling by signal waveform display
function.
#5(TRCSTAT) 0 : Signal tracing starts by soft key [EXEC] in signal trace function.
1 : Signal tracing starts automatically by power on in signal trace
function.
#4(MEMINP) 0 : Data input cannot be done in memory contents display function.
1 : Data input can be done in memory contents display function.
#2(AUTORUN) 0 : A sequence program is executed automatically after the power is
turned on.
1 : A sequence program is executed by sequence program soft key.
#1(PRGRAM) 0 : Built–in programmer is not used.
1 : Built–in programmer is used.
#0(LADMASK) 0 : Dynamic display of ladder is executed.
1 : Dynamic display of ladder is not executed.
260
B–63005EN/01 4.INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC
ÀÀÀÀ ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ
ÀÀÀÀ ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
K018
#7(IGNDINT) 0 : When the screen is switched to the PCMMDI screen, the CRT is initialized.
1 : When the screen is switched to the PCMMDI screen, the CRT is not
initialized.
*It is effective for PMC–RC3/RC4
#5(CHKPRTY) 0 : The parity check is performed for the system ROM and program
ROM/RAM.
1 : The parity check is not performed for the system ROM and program
ROM/RAM.
#4(CALCPRTY) 0 : The built–in programmer function performs RAM parity calculation.
1 : The built–in programmer function does not perform RAM parity
calculation.
#3(TRNSRAM) 0 : A ladder program is not automatically sent to the backup RAM after
on–line editing is completed.
1 : A ladder program is automatically sent to the backup RAM after on–line
editing is completed.
#2(TRGSTAT) 0 : The trigger stop function does not automatically start when the power is
turned on.
1 : The trigger stop function automatically starts when the power is turned on.
#1(DBGSTAT) 0: In the C language debug function, the automatic break processing
does not start when the power is turned on.
1 : In the C language debug function, the automatic break processing
starts when the power is turned on.
*This flag is effective for the PMC–RC3/RC4.
#0(IGNKEY) 0 : Function keys are enabled when a user program displays the user
screen.
1 : Function keys are disabled when a user program displays the user
screen.
*This flag is effective for the PMC–RC3/RC4.
When this bit is set to 1 of the user screen, the screen cannot be switch to
the NC screen using function keys. A program which always sets this bit
to 0 or which changes the screen to the NC screen is required.
ÀÀÀ
ÀÀÀ
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
K019
261
4. INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC B–63005EN/01
No. of screen
ÀÀÀÀÀÀ
PARAMETER
ÀÀÀÀÀÀ
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
K019
0 : Binary format
1 : BCD format
0 : Without protection for input
1 : With protection for input
TYPE
0 : 1–byte length 1 : 2–byte length 2 : 4–byte length
PAGE
262
B–63005EN/01 4.INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC
Group number
Page number
263
4. INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC B–63005EN/01
4.4
LIST OF SIGNALS BY
EACH MODE
D Automatic operation
MODE INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL FEED RATE,
ETC
264
B–63005EN/01 4.INTERFACE BETWEEN NC AND PMC
D Manual operation
MODE INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL FEED RATE,
ETC
D Others
[PMC ⇒ CNC]
MD1∼4 (Mode selection)
*ESP (Emergency stop)
KEY1∼4 (Memory protection key)
MLK,MLKα (All axes/ each axis machine lock)
*IT,*ITα (All axes/ each axis machine lock)
*"MITα (interlock per axis and direction:M series)
STLK (Start lock:T series)
*ABSM (Manual absolute)
SVFα (Servo off)
*FLWP (Follow up)
ERS (External reset)
RRW (Reset & Rewind)
Others EXLM (Stored stroke limit external switching)
"LMα, RLSOT (Software limit external setting M series)
*"Lα (Overtravel limit)
*"EDα (External deceleration of each axis)
[CMC ⇒ PMC]
MA (NC ready)
SA (Servo ready)
AL (NC alarm)
RST (Resetting)
BAL (Battery alarm)
INPα (In–position)
MVα (Axis moving)
TAP (Tapping)
265
5. DIGITAL SERVO B–63005EN/01
5 DIGITAL SERVO
266
B–63005EN/01 5. DIGITAL SERVO
5.1 This section describes how to set initial servo parameters, which is used
for field adjustment of machine tool.
INITIAL SETTING
1. Turn on power at the emergency stop condition.
SERVO PARAMETERS
2. Set the parameter to display the servo tuning screen.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3111 SVS
SERVO SETTING
X AXIS Y AXIS
(1)INITIAL SET BIT 00000000 00000000 PRM 2000
(2)MOTOR ID NO. 47 47 PRM 2020
(3)amr 00000000 00000000 PRM 2001
(4)cmr 2 2 PRM 1820
(5)FEED GEAR N 1 1 PRM 2084
(6) (N/M) M 125 125 PRM 2085
(7)DIRECTION SET 111 111 PRM 2022
(8)VELOCITY PULSE NO. 8192 8192 PRM 2023
(9)POSITION PULSE NO. 12500 12500 PRM 2024
(10)REF.COUNTER 8000 8000 PRM 1821
267
5. DIGITAL SERVO B–63005EN/01
268
B–63005EN/01 5. DIGITAL SERVO
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 Motor model
1 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 5–0S
0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 4–0S, 3–0S
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 other than above
NOTE
Set ”00000000” for serial pulse coder C.
(4) CMR
PRM 1820 Command multiply ratio
NOTE
For serial pulse coder B, use a value not exceeding 250,000
as the number of feedback pulses per revolution.
269
5. DIGITAL SERVO B–63005EN/01
<<Examples of calculation>>
1/1000 mm 1/10000 mm
One revolution 8mm n=1/m=125 n=2/m=25
of motor 10mm n=1/m=100 n=1/m=10
12mm n=3/m=250 n=3/m=25
NOTE
1 NS is the number of position feedback pulses per one
revolution of the motor (multiplied by four)
2 The 5–0S to 3–0S motors have different numbers of poles.
Set parameter 2001.
3 Even if the system employs a closed loop, bit 3 of parameter
2002 is 1 and bit 4 is 0.
270
B–63005EN/01 5. DIGITAL SERVO
The FSSB setting screens include: AMP SET, AXIS SET, and AMP
MAINTENANCE.
Pressing soft key [AMP] causes the AMP SET screen to appear.
Pressing soft key [AXIS] causes the AXIS SET screen to appear.
Pressing soft key [MAINTE] causes the AMP MAINTENANCE
screen to appear.
1) Amplifier setting screen
The amplifier setting screen consists of two sections: the first section
displays information about the slave, while the second section
displays information about the pulse modules.
271
5. DIGITAL SERVO B–63005EN/01
>_
MDI **** *** *** 13:11:56
[ AMP ][ AXIS ][ MAINTE ][ ][(OPRT)]
272
B–63005EN/01 5. DIGITAL SERVO
D TWO AXES
This item is the value specified in bit 0 (parameter 1 DSP) of parameter
No. 1904. It is 1 for an axis (such as a learning control axis, high–speed
current loop axis, or high–speed interface axis) that exclusively uses
a DSP, which is usually shared by two axes.
D Cs: Cs contour controlled axis
This item is the value specified in parameter No. 1933. It is 1 for the
Cs contour controlled axis.
D TANDEM (M series only)
This item is the number specified in parameter No. 1934. Consecutive
odd and even numbers are displayed for the master and slave axes for
tandem control.
3) Amplifier maintenance screen
The amplifier maintenance screen displays maintenance information
for servo amplifiers. This screen consists of the following two pages,
either of which can be selected by pressing the or key.
273
5. DIGITAL SERVO B–63005EN/01
D Setting On an FSSB setting screen (other than the amplifier maintenance screen),
pressing soft key [(OPRT)] displays the following soft keys:
To enter data, place the machine in MDI mode or the emergency stop state,
position the cursor to the point where a desired item is to be input, then
enter the desired data and press soft key [INPUT] (or the INPUT key on the
MDI panel).
When soft key [SET] is pressed after data has been entered, a warning
message is displayed if the entered data contains an error. When the data
is satisfactory, the corresponding parameter is set up.
To restore the previous value of a parameter if, for example, an entered
value is incorrect, press soft key [READ].
When the power is turned on, values are read from the parameters and
displayed on the screen.
CAUTION
1 For the parameters to be specified on the FSSB setting
screen, do not attempt to enter values on the parameter
screen using the MDI or a G10 command. Use only the
FSSB screen to enter values for these parameters.
2 If pressing soft key [SET] results in a warning message
being displayed, retry data entry, or press soft key [READ]
to clear the warning message. Note that pressing the reset
key does not clear the warning message.
274
B–63005EN/01 5. DIGITAL SERVO
>_
MDI **** *** *** 13:11:56
[SETTING][ ][ READ ][ ][ INPUT ]
275
5. DIGITAL SERVO B–63005EN/01
276
B–63005EN/01 5. DIGITAL SERVO
5.2
SERVO TUNING
SCREEN
5.2.2 1. Press SYSTEM key and soft key [SV. PARA] in this order.
2. Press soft key [SV.TUN] to select the servo tuning screen.
SERVO TUNING 01234 N12345
(PAMAMETER) (MONITOR)
(1) FUN.BIT 00000000 ALARM 1 00000000 (9)
(2) LOOP GAIN 3000 ALARM 2 00000000 (10)
(3) TURNING SET. 0 ALARM 3 10000000 (11)
(4) SET PERIOD 50 ALARM 4 00000000 (12)
(5) INT.GAIN 113 ALARM 5 00000000 (13)
(6) PROP.GAIN –1015 LOOP GAIN 2999 (14)
(7) FILER 0 POS ERROR 556 (15)
(8) VELOC.GAIN 125 CURRENT% 10 (16)
SPEED RPM 100 (17)
277
5. DIGITAL SERVO B–63005EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
Alarm1 OVL LV OVC HCA HVA DCA FBA OFA
DGN (200) :
#7 (OVL) : Overload alarm
#6 (LV) : Insufficient voltage alarm
#5 (OVC) : Overcurrent alarm
#4 (HCA) : Abnormal current alarm
#3 (HVA) : Excessive voltage alarm
#2 (DCA) : Discharge alarm
#1 (FBA) : Disconnection alarm
#0 (OFA) : Overflow alarm
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
Alarm2 ALD EXP
DGN (201) ⇓
Over- 0 — — — Amplifier overheat
load
alarm 1 — — — Motor overheat
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
Alarm3 CSA BLA PHA RCA BZA CKA SPH
DGN (202) :
#6 (CSA) : Hardware of serial pulse coder is abnormal.
#5 (BLA) : Battery voltage is in low (warning).
#4 (PHA) : Serial pulse coder or feedback cable is abnormal.
Counting the feedback signal is in error.
#3 (RCA) : Serial pulse coder is faulty.
Counting is in error.
If the RCA bit is set to 1 when both the FBA bit (bit 1 of alarm 1) and
ALD bit of alarm 2 are set to 1 and the EXP bit of alarm 2 (internal
hardware disconnection) is set to 1, a count miss alarm (CMAL)
occurs in the α pulse coder.
#2 (BZA) : Battery voltage becomes 0.
Replace batteries and set the reference position.
#1 (CKA) : Serial pulse coder is faulty.
Internal block has stopped.
#0 (SPH) : Serial pulse coder or feedback cable is faulty.
Counting the feedback signal is in error.
278
B–63005EN/01 5. DIGITAL SERVO
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
Alarm4 DTE CRC STB
DGN (203) :
#7 (DTE) : Communication error of serial pulse coder.
There is no response.
#6 (CRC) : Communication error of serial pulse coder.
Transmitted data is in error.
#5 (STB) : Communication error of serial pulse coder.
Transmitted data is in error.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
Alarm3 OFS MCC LDM PMS
DGN (204) :
#6 (OFS) : A/D conversion of current value of digital servo is abnormal.
#5 (MCC) : Contacts of electro–magnetic contactor of servo amplifier is blown
#4 (LDM) : LED of serial pulse coder is abnormal.
#3 (PMS) : No. of feedback pulses are in error because serial pulse coder C or
feedback cable is faulty.
279
5. DIGITAL SERVO B–63005EN/01
5.3
ADJUSTING
REFERENCE
POSITION
(DOG METHOD)
5.3.1
General
Speed
Rapid traverse
(PRM1420α)
FL rate
(PRM1425 α )
Time
*DECα
PCZ
Grid
10mm/rev
10000P +
Error Proportion Speed M
CMR f gain
Command counter loop
–
4 (Serial)
Refere
GRID count. FFG PC
10000P/rev
Counter capacity
(Flexible feed gear)
10000P
D Parameter
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
PRM 1002 DLZ
280
B–63005EN/01 5. DIGITAL SERVO
When the resolution is 0.0001mm, set the value in the unit ten times
the detection unit.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
PRM 1815 APC APZ OPT
Example)
(1µ m)
300mm ⇒ reference counter 30000
20000
15000
10000 etc
281
5. DIGITAL SERVO B–63005EN/01
5.4 When there are no dog nor limit switch for reference position return, this
function enables the tool to return the reference position that is set by
DOGLESS MTB.
REFERENCE When the absolute position detector is used, the reference position once
POSITION SETTING set remains also during power off. When the absolute detector is replaced
or absolute position is lost, perform this setting.
5.4.1
General
Speed
Time
JOG
ZRN
+Jα
GRID ..........................
ZP α
5.4.2
Operation 1 Move the tool near the reference position using a manual operation.
2 Select the reference position return mode or switch.
3 Press a button for an axis–and–direction–select–signal + or –, and the
machine moves to the next grid, then stops.
(This position is set as the reference position).
After the reference position has been set, select the reference position
return mode(SRN signal is 1) and turn on an axis–and–direction–
select signal, then the tool returns to the reference position.
282
B–63005EN/01 5. DIGITAL SERVO
5.4.3
Associated Parameters
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
PRM 1002 DLZ
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
PRM 1006 ZMI
283
6. AC SPINDLE (SERIAL INTERFACE) B–63005EN/01
This chapter outlines the serial interface and analog interface spindle
amplifiers and explains related parameters.
284
B–63005EN/01 6. AC SPINDLE (SERIAL INTERFACE)
6.1
AC SPINDLE (SERIAL
INTERFACE)
6.1.1
Outline of Spindle
Control
285
6. AC SPINDLE (SERIAL INTERFACE) B–63005EN/01
S instruction M instruction
NC PMC
M03,M04,M05,M19
FIN
*SSTP(Spindle stop)
SF,GR10,GR20,GR30
(For machining center)
GR1,GR2 (For lathe)
S SOR( Orientation)
(PRM 3735X3752)
0
1 R010XR120
Orientation speed
(PRM 3705#1, 3732, R01IXR12I
3706#5) 0 1
SIND
Output polarity
(PRM 3706#7,6) SGN(0=+,1=–)
0 1
SSIN
*ESP,MRDY,
SFR,SRV,ORCM
etc.
SST, SDT, SAR, LDT1,
LDT2
ORAR, ALM etc.
Interface
function
Optical cable
Serial spindle
amplifier Interface
function
Spindle
Operator’s motor
panel PC
Load meter
LM
Speed meter
SM Spindle
286
B–63005EN/01 6. AC SPINDLE (SERIAL INTERFACE)
6.1.1.1
Method A of Gear Output Motor speed
Change for Machining
Center 4095 Max
PRM 3735
0
0 PRM 3741 PRM 3742 PRM 3743 S code
6.1.1.2
Method B of Gear Output Motor speed
Change for Machining
4095 Max
Center(PRM 3705#2=1)
PRM 3736
0 PRM 3735
S code
0 PRM 3741 PRM 3742 PRM 3743
6.1.1.3
For Lathe Output Motor speed
4095 Max
Gear 1 Gear 2 Gear 3
Gear 4
0 S code
0 PRM 3741 PRM 3742 PRM 3743 PRM 3744
287
6. AC SPINDLE (SERIAL INTERFACE) B–63005EN/01
6.1.2
Spindle Setting and
Tuning Screen
6.1.2.1
Display method (1) Confirm the parameters
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3111 SPS
6.1.2.2
Spindle setting screen SPINDLE SETTING
(1)GEAR SELECT : 1
(2)SPINDLE : S11
(PARAMETER)
(3)GEAR RATIO 50
(4)MAX SPINDLE SPEED 3000
(5)MAX MOTOR SPEED 6000
(6)MAX C AXIS SPEED 100
D Gear selection The gear select status on the machine side is displayed.
Indication CTH1 CTH2
1 0 0
2 0 1
3 1 0
4 1 1
288
B–63005EN/01 6. AC SPINDLE (SERIAL INTERFACE)
D Parameters
S11:1st Main S12:1st Sub S21:2nd Main S22:2nd Sub
6.1.2.3
Spindle tuning screen SPINDLE TUNING
D Operation mode
1 : Normal operation
2 : Orientation
3 : Synchronization control
4 : Rigid tapping
5 : Cs contour control
6 : Spindle positioning control
289
6. AC SPINDLE (SERIAL INTERFACE) B–63005EN/01
D Displayed parameters The displayed parameters vary depending on the operation mode.
D Displayed monitoring The displayed monitoring items vary depending on the operation mode.
items
Note 1)
|Spindle data|
Motor speed [rpm] + Max. Motor speed.(* 1)
16383
(*1) Parameter 4020: Main spindleParameter 4196: Subspindle
290
B–63005EN/01 6. AC SPINDLE (SERIAL INTERFACE)
6.1.2.4
Spindle monitor screen SPINDLE MONITOR SCREEN
ALARM : AL–27(POSITION CODER DIS.)
OPERATION : Cs AXIS OONTROL
SPINDLE SPEED : 100 DEG/MIN
MOTOR SPEED : 150 RPM
0 50 100 150 200
LOAD METER (%)
JJJJJ
CONTROL INPUT : ORCM MRDY *ESP
CONTROL OUTPUT : SST SDT ORAR
291
6. AC SPINDLE (SERIAL INTERFACE) B–63005EN/01
D Control input signal Max.10 signals those are ON are displayed from the following signals:
D Control output signals Max. 10 signals those are ON are displayed from the following signals:
292
B–63005EN/01 6. AC SPINDLE (SERIAL INTERFACE)
6.1.2.5
Correspondence
between operation mode
and parameters on
spindle tuning screen
D Orientation mode
293
6. AC SPINDLE (SERIAL INTERFACE) B–63005EN/01
294
B–63005EN/01 6. AC SPINDLE (SERIAL INTERFACE)
D Spindle positioning
control mode
S11: S12: S21: S22:
1st Main 1st Sub 2nd Main 2nd Sub
Proportional gain(HIGH) 4044 4210 4044 4210
Proportional gain (LOW) 4045 4211 4045 4211
Integral gain(HIGH) 4052 4052
4214 4214
Integral gain(LOW) 4053 4053
Position loop gain(HIGH) 4065 4065
4221 4221
Position loop gain(MID,HIGH) 4066 4066
Position loop gain(MID,LOW) 4067 4067
4222 4222
Position loop gain(LOW) 4068 4068
Motor voltage 4085 4238 4085 4238
ZRN gain % 4091 4239 4091 4239
Reference position shift 4073 4223 4073 4223
295
6. AC SPINDLE (SERIAL INTERFACE) B–63005EN/01
6.1.3 The standard parameters related to each motor model can be set
Automatic Setting of automatically.
Standard Parameters D The specifications for controlling a motor depend on the specifications
defined by the machine tool builder. The parameters defined by the
machine tool builder are set as the standard values (initial values) by
this automatic setting function.
Therefore, when performing automatic operation, always set
parameters properly according to the parameter list (parameters
4000 and later).
1. Turn on the power in the emergency stop state.
2. Set bit 7 of parameter 4019 to 1.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
4019 LDSP
Bit 7 (LDSP) The parameters for the serial interface spindle are:
0 : Not set automatically.
l 1 : Set automatically.
4. Turn off the power then back on. Then, the parameters are read.
296
B–63005EN/01 6. AC SPINDLE (SERIAL INTERFACE)
6.2
AC SPINDLE
(ANALOG
INTERFACE)
6.2.1
Outline of Spindle
Control
297
6. AC SPINDLE (SERIAL INTERFACE) B–63005EN/01
6.2.1.1
Block diagram
S command M command
PMC
NC
M03 A M05, M06, M19
CW/CCW command,
Spindle speed orientation, etc.
conversion
FIN Miscellaneous function end
Motor speed *SSTP
Gear 1 Gear 2 Spindle stop
GR1O, GR2O, GR3O
Gear selection (16M/18M)
GR1, GR2
Gear information (16T/18T)
S
DV
SVC
RV
Operator’s panel
Spindle
PC motor Load meter
LM
Speed meter
Spindle SM
298
B–63005EN/01 6. AC SPINDLE (SERIAL INTERFACE)
6.2.1.2
Calculation of S analog
voltage and related
parameters
[M series]
1 Gear change method A (bit 2 of parameter 3705 = 0)
PRM 3735
0V
S code
0 PRM 3741 PRM 3742 PRM 3743 (RPM)
PRM 3752
PRM 3751
PRM 3735
0V
S code
0 PRM 3741 PRM 3742 PRM 3743 (RPM)
[T series]
Constant surface speed control
0V
S code
0 PRM 3741 PRM 3742 PRM 3743 PRM 3744 (RPM)
299
6. AC SPINDLE (SERIAL INTERFACE) B–63005EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3706 TCW CWM
[M series]
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3705 SGB
[T series]
300
B–63005EN/01 6. AC SPINDLE (SERIAL INTERFACE)
6.2.1.3
Tuning S analog voltage
(D/A converter)
(1) For M series, change the upper and lower limits as follows:
⋅ When gear change method A is used: Parameter 3736 = 4095,
parameter 3735 = 0
⋅ When gear change method B is used: Parameter 3751 = 4095,
parameter 3735 = 0
. For T series, these changes are not required.
(2) Tuning the D/A converter offset
Specify zero as the spindle speed. Then, by using a digital multimeter,
adjust the following parameter so that the voltage at the test pin DA2
on the spindle amplifier printed circuit board is 0 mV.
1 For M series
S0; (Specify the command by MDI operation, then press the cycle start button.)
G97 S0; (Specify the command by MDI in the same manner as for M series.)
301
6. AC SPINDLE (SERIAL INTERFACE) B–63005EN/01
(4) If the output voltage is not correct, perform the following calculation,
and change the value of parameter 3730 to adjust the gain of the D/A
converter:
(5) Execute an S command again and confirm that the output voltage is
correct.
.Restore the original parameter values.
302
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
7 TROUBLESHOOTING
303
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
7.1.1
Investigating the
(1) When and how many times (frequency of occurrences)
Conditions under (2) With what operation
which Failure Occurred (3) What failure occurred
304
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
305
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
7.2
NO MANUAL OPERA-
TION NOR AUTOMAT-
IC OPERATION CAN
BE EXECUTED
Points (1) Execute the following procedure when no manual nor automatic
operation is done
(2) Check whether position display shows correct position
(3) Check CNC status display
(4) Check CNC internal status using diagnostic function
Causes and
Countermeasures
1. Position display (1) Check CNC status display (Refer to Section 1.9 NC STATUS
(relative, absolute, DISPLAY for detail.)
machine coordinate) (a) Emergency stop status (Emergency stop signal is turned on)
does not change
If status display shows EMG the emergency stop signal is input.
Check the following signal using the PMC’s diagnostic function
(PMCDGN).
1) When built–in I/O card is used.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
X1008 *ESP
G0008 *ESP
G0008 *ESP
306
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
(2) Check diagnostic data 000 to 025 of the CNC Check an item for which
1 is displayed
No. Message Display
000 WAITING FOR FIN SIGNAL :0
001 MOTION :0
002 DWELL :0
a.003 IN–POSITION CHECK :0
004 FEEDRATE OVERRIDE 0% :0
b.005 INTERLOCK / START LOCK : 1 (Example)
006 SPINDLE SPEED ARRIVAL CHECK :0
010 PUNCHING :0
011 READING :0
012 WAITING FOR (UN) CLAMP :0
c.013 JOG FEEDRATE OVERRIDE 0% :0
d.014 WAITING FOR RESET, ESP, RRW OFF :0
015 EXTERNAL PROGRAM NUMBER SEARCH : 0
Items with a to d relate with manual and automatic operation and its
detail is shown below.
307
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
a. In–position check is It shows that positioning is not yet completed. Check the contents of the
being done following diagnostic number. (It is 1 in the following condition)
2) Servo system may be abnormal. Refer to servo alarm 400, 410, and
411.
b. Interlock or start lock There are a plural interlock signals. Check at first which interlock signal
signal is input is used by the machine tool builder at the parameters shown below.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3003 DIT ITX ITL
308
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
c. Jog feedrate override is Check the signals using PMC’s diagnostic function (PMCDGN)
0%
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
G0010 *JV7 *JV6 *JV5 *JV4 *JV3 *JV2 *JV1 *JV0
: :
1101 1000 1110 1111 100.00%
: :
0000 0000 0000 0001 655.34%
0000 0000 0000 0000 0.00%
d. NC is in a reset state In this case, RESET is also displayed on the status display. Check it using
the procedure of 1 above.
309
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
7.3
JOG OPERATION
CANNOT BE DONE
1. Position display (1) Check mode selection status (JOG mode is not selected).
(relative, absolute, When status display shows JOG, it is normal.
machine cooordinate) When status display does not show JOG, mode select signal is not
does not change selected correctly. Confirm the mode select signal using PMC’s
diagnostic function (PMCDGN).
<Mode select signal>
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
G0043 MD4 MD2 MD1
↓ ↓ ↓
Manual operation (JOG) mode 1 0 1
(2) Feed axis and direction select signal is not input Check the signal using
PMC’s diagnostic function (PMCDGN).
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
G0100 +J8 +J7 +J6 +J5 +J4 +J3 +J2 +J1
Example)
When +X button is pressed on the operator’s panel, signal+J1 turns to
1.
This signal is effected at its rise. If axis selection signal is input before
JOG mode is selected, axis movement does not occur. Turn the signal
to off, then on.
310
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
(3) Check CNC’s diagnostic function 000 to 015. Check the items for
which 1 is displayed at right side.
No. Message Display
000 WAITING FOR FIN SIGNAL :0
001 MOTION :0
002 DWELL :0
a. 003 IN–POSITION CHECK :0
004 FEEDRATE OVERRIDE 0% :0
b. 005 INTERLOCK / START LOCK : 1(Example)
006 SPINDLE SPEED ARRIVAL CHECK :0
010 PUNCHING :0
011 READING :0
012 WAITING FOR (UN) CLAMP :0
c. 013 JOG FEEDRATE OVERRIDE 0% :0
d. 014 WAITING FOR RESET, ESP, RRW OFF :0
015 EXTERNAL PROGRAM NUMBER SEARCH : 0
Items with a to d relate with manual and automatic operation and its
detail is shown below.
311
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
a. In–position check is It shows that positioning is not yet completed. Check the contents of the
being done following diagnostic number. (It is 1 in the following condition)
DGN 0300 Position Error >PARAM 1826 In–positio width
1) Check the parameters according to the parameter list.
1825 Servo loop gain per axis (Normal : 3000)
2) Servo system may be abnormal. Refer to servo alarm 400, 410, and
411.
b. Interlock or start lock There are a plural interlock signals. Check at first which interlock signal
signal is input is used by the machine tool builder at the parameters shown below.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
PARAM 3003 DIT ITX ITL
⋅ T series
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
X0004 –MIT2 +MIT2 –MIT1 +MIT1
312
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
c. Jog feedrate override is Check the signals using PMC’s diagnostic function (PMCDGN)
0%
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
G0010 *JV7 *JV6 *JV5 *JV4 *JV3 *JV2 *JV1 *JV0
: :
1101 1000 1110 1111 100.00%
: :
0000 0000 0000 0001 655.34%
0000 0000 0000 0000 0.00%
d. NC is in a reset state In this case, RESET is also displayed on the status display. Check it using
the procedure of 1 above.
(4) Jog feed rate setting (Parameter) is not correct.
1423 Jog feedrate per axis
313
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
7.4
HANDLE OPERATION
CANNOT BE DONE
Points (1) Check another manual operation (JOG) is accepted.
(2) Check CNC status display.
Causes and
Countermeasure
2 When only handle (1) Check CNC status display at lower left corner of the CRT.
operation (MPG) cannot (Refer to 1.7 STATUS DISPLAY for details)
be done When the status display shows HND, mode selection is correct.
If it is not HND, mode select signal is not input correctly. Check the
mode select signal using the PMC’s diagnostic function(PMCDGN).
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
G0043 MD4 MD2 MD1
↓ ↓ ↓
Manuale handle mode 1 0 0
When axis select switch for manual handle feed is selected on the
machine operator’s panel, if the signals are input as follows, it is
normal.
Selected axis HSnD HSnC HSnB HSnA
no selection 0 0 0 0
1st axis 0 0 0 1
2nd axis 0 0 1 0
3rd axis 0 0 1 1
4th axis 0 1 0 0
5th axis 0 1 0 1
6th axis 0 1 1 0
7th axis 0 1 1 1
8th axis 1 0 0 0
314
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
↓ ↓
MP2 MP1 Multiplication
0 0 1
1 0 10
0 1 m
1 1 n
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
7102 HNGx
#2 2nd MPG
#3 3rd MPG
315
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
Manual pulse
CNC side MPG (JA3) generator
HA1 (03) (05) HA1 1st
HB1 (02) (06) HB1
+5V (09) (03) +5V
0V (12) (04) 0V
Back of MPG
+5V 0V HA HB
+5V
HA on off on off
0V
+5V
HB on off on off
0V
1:1
1/4 phase difference 1/4 phase difference
316
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
7.5
AUTOMATIC
OPERATION
CANNOT BE DONE
Points (1) Check manual operation is possible.
(2) Check the status of cycle start LED on machine operator’s manual.
(3) Check status of CNC.
Causes and Remedies When manual operation is either impossible, perform countermeasure,
based on the previous item ”Jog operation cannot be done”.
Confirm that a correct mode is selected according to the mode select status
of CNC status display. Also, by confirming the automatic operation
status it is possible to identify cycle operation, feed hold and cycle stop
state.
317
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3001 HSIF
318
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
<M series>
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
G0005 BFIN TFIN SFIN MFIN
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
F0007 BF TF SF MF
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
F0007 BF TF SF MF
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
G0008 MF3 MF2
319
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
b. Travel command is being CNC is reading an axis command (X,Y,Z,...) in a program and giving the
executed command to the axis.
c. A dwell command is CNC is reading a dwell command (G04) in a program and is executing
being executed the dwell command.
320
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
*ITn When the bit is 0, the corresponding axis’s interlock signal is input.
3) Interlock signal per axis and direction(+/– MITn) is input
⋅ M series
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
G0132 +MIT4 +MIT3 +MIT2 +MIT1
⋅ T series
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
X0004 –MIT2 +MIT2 –MIT1 +MIT1
321
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
g. CNC is waiting for Actual spindle speed does not arrive at a speed specified in a program.
spindle speed arrival Confirm the signal state using the PMC’s diagnostic function
signal to be input (PMCDGN).
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
G0029 SAR
#4(SAR) : When this signal is 0, spindle speed does not arrive at the specified speed.
h. Manual feedrate override Normally manual feedrate override function is used for jog feed.
is 0% (dry run) But when DRN(dry run) signal turns on during an auomatic
operation,override values set with these signals become valid to the
following speed set by a parameter.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
G0046 DRN
322
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
i. NC is in a reset state In this case, the CNC’s status display shows RESET. Refer to item 1.
(2) Only rapid traverse in positioning (G00) does not function Confirm
the following parameter and signals from the PMC.
(a) Setting value of rapid traverse rate
1420 Rapid traverse rate per axis
(HROV–0) (HROV=1)
323
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
<T series>
Whether A/B phase signals from the position coder are read
correctly, can be judged also by the spindle speed display on the
CRT screen (position screen). (However, it is not displayed
when PARAM 3105#2=0).
CNC Position
coder
JA7B JY2
JA41
SPM
JA7A TB2 Spindle
motor
Position
coder
JA7B JY2
SPM
JA7A TB2 Spindle
motor
CNC
JA41 Position
coder
324
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
7.6
CYCLE START LED
SIGNAL HAS TURNED
OFF
Points (1) After cycle operation is started, then stopped, check as follows:
(2) Confirm cycle start LED on machine operator’s panel.
(3) Confirm CNC’s diagnostic function.
Causes and Remedies The reason why cycle start LED signal (STL) has turned off are displayed
on CNC’s diagnostic numbers 020 to 025 as follows:
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
X1008 *ESP
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
G0008 *ESP
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
G0008 *ESP
325
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
c. Reset button on the MDI An automatic operation is put into a reset status when RESET key on the
is pressed MDI panel is pressed.
#6(RRW) : When this signal is 1, the reset & rewind signal is input.
This signal is usually used for a confirmation signal of M30 when an M30
is specified in a program as the end of a program.
Therefore, when M30 is executed, this signal is input.
e. Servo alarm has When any servo alarm has generated, cycle operation is put into the reset
generated state and operation stop.
f. Cycle operation is in a The cycle operation becomes feed hold state in the following cases:
feed hold state 1) Modes are switched from an automatic operation mode to a manual
operation mode.
2) Feed hold signal is input.
<Mode select signal>
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
G0043 MD4 MD2 MD1
memory edit(EDIT) 0 1 1
Automatic Automatic operation 0 0 1
operation (AUTO)
Manual data input (MDI) 0 0 0
Jog feed (JOG) 1 0 0
M
Manual l Handle/step 1 0 1
operation
o eration
TEACH IN HANDLE 1 1 1
TEACH IN JOG 1 1 0
326
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
7.7
NO DISPLAY
APPEARS AT
POWER–UP
Points Check whether this problem is caused by (1) a trouble in the display
system or (2) a system failure.
Determining the point Check that the LEDs on the motherboard are in the status shown below.
( :On :Off )
JD36A
CA55 CA54
CP1A
CP1B
LED
LED1 LED2
LED3 LED4
STATUS (green)
SERVO SYSEMG
SYSFAIL PARITY
ALARM (orange)
327
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
( : On : Off )
LED positions
JD33 CA54
CA55
LED
LED8
LED9
LED10
LED11
LED12
LED13
LED14
LED1
LED2
LED3
LED4
LED5
LED6
LED7
328
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
7.8
ALARM 85 TO 87
(READER/PUNCHER (START)
INTERFACE ALARM)
YES
Alarm 85?
NO
Is I/O NO
parameter
correct?
OFF
Is power of I/O ?
ON
Turn on I/O device
Is cable NO
connection right?
YES
Connect the cable
329
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
<Parameter>
Value of parame-
ter 0020 0 1 2 3
Function
Feed 0101#7 0111#7 0121#7 0131#7
Data input code 0101#3 0111#3 0121#3 0131#3
Stop bit 0101#0 0111#0 0121#0 0131#0
Type of I/O device 102 112 122 132
Baud rate 103 113 123 133
Commu- 0135#3 – – – 0 1
nication
method RS–232C RS–422
NOTE
For data communications by RS–422, refer to parameters
134 and 135.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
0101 NFD ASI SB2
0111
0121
0131
#7(NFD) 0 : Feed is output before and after data in data output (FANUC PPR)
1 : Feed is not output (standard).
#3(ASI) 0 : Data input code is EIA or ISO (automatic recognition)
1 : Data input code is ASCII.
#0(SB2) 0 : No. of stop bits is 1.
1 : No. of stop bits is 2.
330
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
4 Not used
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
0134 CLK NCD SYN PRY
#5(CLK) 0 : Internal clock is used for baud rate clock of RS–422 interface.
1 : External clock is used for baud rate clock of RS–422 interface.
#4(NCD) 0 : CD (signal quality detection) of RS–232C interface is checked.
1 : CD (signal quality detection) of RS–232C interface is not checked.
#2(SYN) 0 : In protocol B, NC reset/alarm is not informed to the host.
1 : In protocol B, NC reset/alarm is informed to the host by SYN and
NAK code.
#1(PRY) 0 : No parity bit
1 : With parity bit
331
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
0135 RMS R42 PRA ETX ASC
332
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
Mother board
R232C(JD36A)
Punch panel
R232C(JD36B)
Tape reader
Serial
communication R232C(JD28A)
Host computer
R232C(JD6A)
Host computer
333
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
R232C (JD36A)
Punch panel
R232C (JD36B)
RD (01) (03) RD
0V (02)
DR (03) (06) DR
0V (04)
CS (05) (05) CS
0V (06)
CD (07) (08) CD
0V (08)
(09)
+24V (10)
SD (11) (02) SD
0V (12)
ER (13) (20) ER
0V (14)
RS (15) (04) RS
0V (16) (07) SG
(17)
(18)
+24V (19) (25) +24V
(20) (01) FG
Shield
G G Connector :DBM–25S
Connector : Half–pitch 20–pins
RD (01) (02) SD
0V (02)
DR (03) (20) ER
0V (04)
CS (05) (04) RS
0V (06)
CD (07) (08) CD
0V (08)
(09)
+24V (10)
SD (11) (03) RD
0V (12)
ER (13) (06) DR
0V (14)
RS (15) (05) CS
0V (16) (07) SG
(17)
(18)
+24V (19) (25) +24V
(20) (01) FG
Shield
G Connector D–SUB 25 pins
Connector : Half–pitch 20–pins
334
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
CAUTION
1 When CS is not used, connect it to RS.
2 For protocol A or extended protocol A: When DR is not used,
connect it to ER. Always connect CD to ER.
RD (01) (04) RD
*RD (02) (22) *RD
RT (03) (17) TT
*RT (04) (35) *TT
CS (05) (07) RS
*CS (06) (25) *RS
DM (07) (12) TR
Note) *DM (09) (30) *TR
0V (08) (19) SG
(+24V) (10)
SD (11) (06) RD
*SD (12) (24) *RD
TT (13) (08) RT
*TT (14) (26) *RT
RS (15) (09) CS
*RS (16) (27) *CS
TR (17) (11) DM
*TR (18) (29) *DM
(+24V) (19)
(20) (01) FG
Shield
G
Connector : Half–pitch 20 pins (PCR) Connector : D–SUB 25 pins
CAUTION
Always use a twisted pair cable.
335
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
7.9
ALARM 90
(REFERENCE
POSITION RETURN IS
ABNORMAL)
Contents Reference position return was executed when the following condition is
not satisfied:
The CNC received one rotation signal at least one time when the axis is
moving to the reference position at a speed higher than a speed equivalent
to 128 pulses of position error amount(DGN300).
Countermeasures
(START)
Position error
Check whether position gain is greater than 128 pulses amount : 300
(DGN 300) before or during reference position return.
YES
128 or more (1) Next page
NO
336
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
(1)
NO
More than 4.75V
YES
CAUTION
1 After the pulse coder or motor is exchanged, reference
position or machine’s standard point may be different from
former one. Please set it correctly.
2 When the main board is exchanged, all the data stored in
memory is lost. Reset all the NC data again, referring to the
data input/output item.
D Reference A speed more than 128 pulses is required because if speed is lower that
this, one–rotation signal does not function stably, causing improper
position detection.
If bit 0 of parameter No. 2000 is set to 1, a speed corresponding to a
positional deviation of 1280 pulses or more is required.
Parameter No. 1836 can be set to 128 or less, as the minimum positional
deviation with which reference position return is possible. (If the
parameter is set to 0, 128 is assumed as the minimum positional deviation.
If bit 0 of parameter No. 2000 is set to 1, a value equal to ten times the
set value is used for checking.)
337
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
7.10 Absolute position data in the serial pulse coder was lost.
(This alarm will be generated when serial pulse coder is exchanged or
ALARM 300 position feedback signal cable of the serial pulse coder is disconnected).
(REQUEST FOR
REFERENCE
POSITION RETURN)
D When reference position (1) Execute manual reference position return only for an axis for which
return function is this alarm was generated.When manual reference position return
present cannot be executed because of an another alarm, set parameter 1815#5
to 0 and release the alarm and perform manual operation.
(2) Press RESET key at the end of reference position return to release the
alarm.
D When reference position Execute dogless reference position setting to memorize the reference
return function is not position.
present
D When serial pulse coder Since the reference position is different from the former one, change the
is changed grid shift value (PRM 1850) to correct the position.
Related parameters
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
1815 APC x APZx
338
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
D Causes
1 Confirm the setting value of the following parameters:
PRM 2020 : Motor format number
PRM 2022 : Motor rotation direction
PRM 2023 : Number of pulses of velocity feedbacks
PRM 2024 : Number of pulses of position feedback
PRM 1023 : Servo axis number
PRM 2084 : Flexible feed gear ratio
PRM 2085 : Flexible feed gear ratio
Confirm the details with diagnosis function of CNC side.
2 Change the setting of this parameter to 0.
PRM 2047 : Observer parameter
3 Perform initial setting of digital servo parameters.
Refer to setcion 5.1 “Initial Setting of Servo Parameters” .
This data indicates the cause of servo alarm No. 417, detected by the NC.
If the alarm is detected by the servo, the PRM bit (bit 4 of DGN No. 0203)
is set to 1.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
0280 AXS DIR PLS PLC MOT
#0(MOT) : The motor type specified in parameter No. 2020 falls outside the
predetermined range.
#2(PLC) : The number of velocity feedback pulses per motor revolution, specified in
parameter No. 2023, is zero or less. The value is invalid.
#3(PLS) : The number of position feedback pulses per motor revolution, specified in
parameter No. 2024, is zero or less. The value is invalid.
#4(DIR) : The wrong direction of rotation for the motor is specified in parameter No.
2022 (the value is other than 111 or –111).
#6(AXS) : In parameter No. 1023 (servo axis number), a value that falls outside the
range of 1 to the number of controlled axes is specified. (For example, 4 is
specified instead of 3.) Alternatively, the values specified in the
parameter are not consecutive.
339
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
YES
Constant ?
NO
YES
Worn ?
Replace tool
NO
Remedies
PRM 4911 : A ratio of spindle speed at which actual spindle speed is
regarded as arrived at a command spindle speed.
PRM 4913 : Spindle speed fluctuation that is not regarded as the spindle
speed fluctuation alarm.
PRM 4914 : Time when a spindle speed changed to when spindle speed
fluctuation detection is started.
340
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
Main
CPU
Optical cable
System control module is faulty. (Bold line in the figure below indicates
module mounting position.)
A cable between the mother board and optical I/O link adapter is
disconnected or short–circuited.
Optical I/O link adapter is faulty.
Optical cable is disconnected.
Serial spindle amplifier is faulty.
341
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
7.14 When the spindle amplifier does not become normal state immediately
after power is turned on in the serial spindle system, this alarm is
ALARM 750 (SPINDLE informed.
SERIAL LINK
CANNOT BE
STARTED)
Points This alarm does not occur once the system becomes ready including the
spindle system .
This alarm occurs during power on sequence before the system becomes
ready.
After the system becomes ready, serial spindle alarm is issued by alarm
749.
Causes
(1) Optical cable is in poor contact or spindle amplifier power is off.
(2) When display of spindle amplifier shows SU–01 or an alarm other than
AL–24 is displayed, power to the NC is turned on.
In this case, this alarm usually occurs when the NC’s power is turned
off while the serial spindle is operating. Turn off the power of serial
spindle once, then turn it on and starts the system.
(3) Combination of hardware is wrong.
(4) When the 2nd spindle is at the state of (1) to (3).
When the 2nd spindle is used, parameter is set as follows :
Bit 4 of parameter no.3701 is 1: No. of serial spindles connected is 2.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
DGN 0409 SPE S2E S1E SHE
#3(SPE) 0 : In spindle serial control, the serial spindle parameters satisfies the
starting conditions for spindle amplifier.
1 : In spindle serial control, the serial spindle parameters do not satisfy
the starting conditions for spindle amplifier.
#2(S2E) 0 : At the start of spindle serial control, the spindle is normal.
1 : At the start of spindle serial control, the spindle is abnormal.
#1(S1E) 0 : The serial communication module of the CNC side is normal.
1 : The serial communication module of the CNC side is abnormal.
#0(SPE) 0 : Serial communication module on the CNC side is normal.
1 : Serial communication module was detected to be abnormal on the
CNC side.
342
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
343
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
NO
Operating
YES
YES
High tempera-
ture ?
NO
344
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
Confirm the series and versions of control software those are displayed
on upper right of the screen.
*FROM module may be written data by machine tool builder.
345
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
Motherboard
The FROM module is mounted
below the axis control card.
Remove the axis control card ac-
cording to Section 2.6.
FROM module
Connector
346
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
NOTE
1 If an SRAM parity alarm occurs in a module other than the
motherboard, ALM972 NMI OCCURRED IN OTHER
MODULE appears.
2 If a parity alarm occurs in a system that has been kept
switched off for a long time, it is likely that the battery life has
expired or the backup circuit (on the motherboard) is
defective.
347
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
Motherboard
The SRAM module is mounted
below the display control card.
Remove the axis control card ac-
cording to Section 2.6.
SRAM module
Connector
348
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
Motherboard
DRAM module
Connector
349
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
7.19 920: Watch dog alarm or RAM parity in servo control module
has occurred in servo control module on the mother board
ALARM 920, 921 921: Above alarm has occurred in servo control module on the sub CPM
(WATCH DOG OR board
RAM PARITY)
points
D Watch dog timer alarm The timer used to monitor the operation of CPU is called the watch dog
timer. The CPU resets timer time every time a constant time has passed.
When an error occurs in CPU or peripheral device, timer is not reset but
the alarm is informed.
Main
CPU
A20B–3300–0030, 31
RAM A17B–3300–0100, 101
D Mother board is faulty CPU or peripheral circuits may be faulty. Replace the mother board or
CPU card.
D CNC control software Software may not work properly due to failure of FROM module. Change
ROM module is faulty FROM module.
350
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
Motherboard
The FROM module is mounted be-
low the axis control card.
Remove the axis control card ac-
cording to Section 2.6.
FROM module
Connector
<Sub–CPU board>
(1) (2)
Axis control card CPU card
Sub–CPU board
A20B–8001–0630
351
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
D Causes and remedies Check installation of servo module on mother or sub CPU board.
For location of servo module, refer to an installation diagram of alarm 920
and 921.
Unless these boards are mounted correctly, if this alarm still generates,
change mother board, sub CPU board and/ or servo module.
352
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
353
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
354
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
Connector
Motherboard
FROM module
Connector
DRAM module
The DRAM module is
mounted on the CPU card.
Remove the CPU card ac-
cording to Section 2.6.
Side B of CPU card
355
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
D Mounting positions of
the CPU card and
DRAM module The DRAM module is
mounted on the CPU card.
Remove the CPU card ac-
cording to Section 2.6.
(1)
CPU card
C board
DRAM module
356
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
357
7. TROUBLESHOOTING B–63005EN/01
7.24 NMI has generated in a board other than the main CPU board.
ALARM 972
(NMI ALARM)
Causes and Remedies 1) Any of option boards shown below may be faulty.
⋅ Serial communication board
⋅ Sub CPU board
⋅ C language board
⋅ CAP–II board
⋅ RISC board
⋅ Data server board
⋅ Loader control board
SLOT 02
Indicates the slot No.
915 SRAM PARITY : (2N+1) <SUB where an NMI occurred,
and the relevant mes-
sage.
CAUTION
When you change CAP–II board, Loader control board, you
must input data (parameters, programs, etc.) on sub side.
358
B–63005EN/01 7.TROUBLESHOOTING
CAUTION
When the main CPU board is replaced, all the data in
memory is lost. Set the NC data (parameter, offset and
program etc) again.
CAUTION
When you change the CAP–II board, Loader control boards
board, you must input data (parameters, programs,etc.) on
the sub side.
359
APPENDIX
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
A
363
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
A.1
LIST OF ALARM
CODES
(1) Program errors /Alarms on program and operation (P/S alarm)
000 PLEASE TURN OFF POWER A parameter which requires the power off was input, turn off power.
001 TH PARITY ALARM TH alarm (A character with incorrect parity was input).
Correct the tape.
002 TV PARITY ALARM TV alarm (The number of characters in a block is odd). This alarm will
be generated only when the TV check is effective.
003 TOO MANY DIGITS Data exceeding the maximum allowable number of digits was input.
(Refer to the item of max. programmable dimensions.)
004 ADDRESS NOT FOUND A numeral or the sign “ – ” was input without an address at the beginning
of a block. Modify the program .
005 NO DATA AFTER ADDRESS The address was not followed by the appropriate data but was followed
by another address or EOB code. Modify the program.
006 ILLEGAL USE OF NEGATIVE SIGN Sign “ – ” input error (Sign “ – ” was input after an address with which it
cannot be used. Or two or more “ – ” signs were input.)
Modify the program.
007 ILLEGAL USE OF DECIMAL POINT Decimal point “ . ” input error (A decimal point was input after an address
with which it can not be used. Or two decimal points were input.)
Modify the program.
009 ILLEGAL ADDRESS INPUT Unusable character was input in significant area.
Modify the program.
010 IMPROPER G–CODE An unusable G code or G code corresponding to the function not pro-
vided is specified. Modify the program.
011 NO FEEDRATE COMMANDED Feedrate was not commanded to a cutting feed or the feedrate was in-
adequate. Modify the program.
CAN NOT COMMAND G95 A synchronous feed is specified without the option for threading / syn-
(M series) chronous feed.
014 ILLEGAL LEAD COMMAND In variable lead threading, the lead incremental and decremental out-
(T series) putted by address K exceed the maximum command value or a com-
mand such that the lead becomes a negative value is given.
Modify the program.
TOO MANY AXES COMMANDED An attempt was made to move the machine along the axes, but the num-
(M series) ber of the axes exceeded the specified number of axes controlled simul-
taneously. Modify the program.
TOO MANY AXES COMMANDED An attempt has been made to move the tool along more than the maxi-
015 (T series) mum number of simultaneously controlled axes. Alternatively, no axis
movement command or an axis movement command for two or more
axes has been specified in the block containing the command for skip
using the torque limit signal (G31 P99/98). The command must be ac-
companied with an axis movement command for a single axis, in the
same block.
020 OVER TOLERANCE OF RADIUS In circular interpolation (G02 or G03), difference of the distance between
the start point and the center of an arc and that between the end point
and the center of the arc exceeded the value specified in parameter No.
3410.
021 ILLEGAL PLANE AXIS COMMAN- An axis not included in the selected plane (by using G17, G18, G19) was
DED commanded in circular interpolation. Modify the program.
022 NO CIRCLE RADIUS The command for circular interpolation lacks arc radius R or coordinate
I, J, or K of the distance between the start point to the center of the arc.
364
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
023 ILLEGAL RADIUS COMMAND In circular interpolation by radius designation, negative value was com-
(T series) manded for address R. Modify the program.
025 CANNOT COMMAND F0 IN G02/G03 F0 (fast feed) was instructed by F1 –digit column feed in circular inter-
(M series) polation. Modify the program.
027 NO AXES COMMANDED IN No axis is specified in G43 and G44 blocks for the tool length offset type
G43/G44 (M series) C.
Offset is not canceled but another axis is offset for the tool length offset
type C. Modify the program.
028 ILLEGAL PLANE SELECT In the plane selection command, two or more axes in the same direction
are commanded.
Modify the program.
ILLEGAL OFFSET VALUE The offset values specified by H code is too large.
(M series) Modify the program.
029
ILLEGAL OFFSET VALUE The offset values specified by T code is too large.
(T series) Modify the program.
ILLEGAL OFFSET NUMBER The offset number specified by D/H code for tool length offset or cutter
(M series) compensation is too large. Modify the program.
030
ILLEGAL OFFSET NUMBER The offset number in T function specified for tool offset is tool large.
(T series) Modify the program.
031 ILLEGAL P COMMAND IN G10 In setting an offset amount by G10, the offset number following address
P was excessive or it was not specified.
Modify the program.
032 ILLEGAL OFFSET VALUE IN G10 In setting an offset amount by G10 or in writing an offset amount by sys-
tem variables, the offset amount was excessive.
NO SOLUTION AT CRC A point of intersection cannot be determined for cutter compensation.
(M series) Modify the program.
033
NO SOLUTION AT CRC A point of intersection cannot be determined for tool nose radius com-
(T series) pensation. Modify the program.
NO CIRC ALLOWED IN ST–UP /EXT The start up or cancel was going to be performed in the G02 or G03
BLK (M series) mode in cutter compensation C. Modify the program.
034
NO CIRC ALLOWED IN ST–UP /EXT The start up or cancel was going to be performed in the G02 or G03
BLK (T series) mode in tool nose radius compensation. Modify the program.
CAN NOT COMMANDED G39 G39 is commanded in cutter compensation B cancel mode or on the
(M series) plane other than offset plane. Modify the program.
035
CAN NOT COMMANDED G31 Skip cutting (G31) was specified in tool nose radius compensation
(T series) mode. Modify the program.
036 CAN NOT COMMANDED G31 Skip cutting (G31) was specified in cutter compensation mode.
(M series) Modify the program.
CAN NOT CHANGE PLANE IN CRC G40 is commanded on the plane other than offset plane in cutter com-
(M seires) pensation B. The plane selected by using G17, G18 or G19 is changed
037 in cutter compensation C mode. Modify the program.
CAN NOT CHANGE PLANE IN NRC The offset plane is switched in tool nose radius compensation.
(T seires) Modify the program.
INTERFERENCE IN CIRCULAR Overcutting will occur in cutter compensation C because the arc start
BLOCK (M seires) point or end point coincides with the arc center.
Modify the program.
038
INTERFERENCE IN CIRCULAR Overcutting will occur in tool nose radius compensation because the arc
BLOCK (T series) start point or end point coincides with the arc center.
Modify the program.
365
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
039 CHF/CNR NOT ALLOWED IN NRC Chamfering or corner R was specified with a start–up, a cancel, or
(T series) switching between G41 and G42 in tool nose radius compensation. The
program may cause overcutting to occur in chamfering or corner R.
Modify the program.
040 INTERFERENCE IN G90/G94 Overcutting will occur in tool nose radius compensation in canned cycle
BLOCK (T series) G90 or G94. Modify the program.
INTERFERENCE IN CRC Overcutting will occur in cutter compensation C. Two or more blocks are
(M seires) consecutively specified in which functions such as the auxiliary function
and dwell functions are performed without movement in the cutter com-
041 pensation mode. Modify the program.
INTERFERENCE IN NRC Overcutting will occur in tool nose radius compensation.
(T seires) Modify the program.
042 G45/G48 NOT ALLOWED IN CRC Tool offset (G45 to G48) is commanded in cutter compensation. Modify
(M series) the program.
043 ILLEGAL T–CODE COMMAND In a system using the DRILL–MATE with an ATC, a T code was not spe-
(M series) cified together with the M06 code in a block. Alternatively, the Tcode was
out of range.
044 G27–G30 NOT ALLOWED IN FIXED One of G27 to G30 is commanded in canned cycle mode.
CYC (M series) Modify the program.
046 ILLEGAL REFERENCE RETURN Other than P2, P3 and P4 are commanded for 2nd, 3rd and 4th refer-
COMMAND ence position return command.
047 ILLEGAL AXIS SELECT Two or more parallel axes (in parallel with a basic axis) have been speci-
(M series) fied upon start–up of three–dimensional tool compensation or three–di-
mensional coordinate conversion.
048 BASIC 3 AXIS NOT FOUND Start–up of three–dimensional tool compensation or three–dimensional
(M series) coordinate conversion has been attempted, but the three basic axes
used when Xp, Yp, or Zp is omitted are not set in parameter No. 1022.
050 CHF/CNR NOT ALLOWED IN THRD Optional chamfering or corner R is commanded in the thread cutting
BLK (M series) block.
Modify the program.
CHF/CNR NOT ALLOWED IN THRD Chamfering or corner R is commanded in the thread cutting block.
BLK(T series) Modify the program.
051 MISSING MOVE AFTER CHF/CNR Improper movement or the move distance was specified in the block
(M series) next to the optional chamfering or corner R block.
Modify the program.
MISSING MOVE AFTER CHF/CNR Improper movement or the move distance was specified in the block
(T series) next to the chamfering or corner R block.
Modify the program.
CODE IS NOT G01 AFTER CHF/CNR The block next to the chamfering or corner R block is not G01,G02 or
(M series) G03.
052 Modify the program.
CODE IS NOT G01 AFTER CHF/CNR The block next to the chamfering or corner R block is not G01.
(T series) Modify the program.
TOO MANY ADDRESS COMMANDS For systems without the arbitary angle chamfering or corner R cutting,
(M series) a comma was specified. For systems with this feature, a comma was fol-
lowed by something other than R or C Correct the program.
053
TOO MANY ADDRESS COMMANDS In the chamfering and corner R commands, two or more of I, K and R
(T seires) are specified. Otherwise, the character after a comma(”,”) is not C or R
in direct drawing dimensions programming. Modify the program.
NO TAPER ALLOWED AFTER CHF/ A block in which chamfering in the specified angle or the corner R was
054
CNR (T series) specified includes a taper command. Modify the program.
366
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
MISSING MOVE VALUE IN CHF/CNR In the arbitrary angle chamfering or corner R block, the move distance
(M series) is less than chamfer or corner R amount.
055
MISSING MOVE VALUE IN CHF/CNR In chamfering or corner R block, the move distance is less than chamfer
(T series) or corner R amount.
056 NO END POINT & ANGLE IN CHF/ Neither the end point nor angle is specified in the command for the block
CNR (T series) next to that for which only the angle is specified (A). In the chamfering
comman, I(K) is commanded for the X(Z) axis.
057 NO SOLUTION OF BLOCK END Block end point is not calculated correctly in direct dimension drawing
(T series) programming.
END POINT NOT FOUND In a arbitrary angle chamfering or corner R cutting block, a specified axis
(M series) is not in the selected plane. Correct the program.
058
END POINT NOT FOUND Block end point is not found in direct dimension drawing programming.
(T series)
059 PROGRAM NUMBER NOT FOUND In an external program number search, a specified program number
was not found. Otherwise, a program specified for searching is being
edited in background processing. Check the program number and ex-
ternal signal. Or discontinue the background eiting.
060 SEQUENCE NUMBER NOT FOUND Commanded sequence number was not found in the sequence number
search. Check the sequence number.
061 ADDRESS P/Q NOT FOUND IN Address P or Q is not specified in G70, G71, G72, or G73 command.
G70–G73 (T series) Modify the program.
062 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN G71–G76 1. The depth of cut in G71 or G72 is zero or negative value.
(T series) 2. The repetitive count in G73 is zero or negative value.
3. the negative value is specified to ∆i or ∆k is zero in G74 or G75.
4. A value other than zero is specified to address U or W though ∆i or
∆k is zero in G74 or G75.
5. A negative value is specified to ∆d, thoughthe relief direction in G74
or G75 is determined.
6. Zero or a negative value is specified to the height of thread or depth
of cut of first time in G76.
7. The specified minimum depth of cut in G76 is greater than the height
of thread.
8. An unusable angle of tool tip is specified in G76.
Modify the program.
063 SEQUENCE NUMBER NOT FOUND The sequence number specified by address P in G70, G71, G72, or G73
(T series) command cannot be searched. Modify the program.
064 SHAPE PROGRAM NOT MONOTO- A target shape which cannot be made by monotonic machining was
NOUSLY (T series) specified in a repetitive canned cycle (G71 or G72).
065 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN G71–G73 1. G00 or G01 is not commanded at the block with the sequence num-
(T series) ber which is specified by address P in G71, G72, or G73 command.
2. Address Z(W) or X(U) was commanded in the block with a sequence
number which is specified by address P in G71 or G72, respectively.
Modify the program.
066 IMPROPER G–CODE IN G71–G73 An unallowable G code was commanded beween two blocks specified
(T series) by address P in G71, G72, or G73. Modify the program.
067 CAN NOT ERROR IN MDI MODE G70, G71, G72, or G73 command with address P and Q.
(T series) Modify the program.
069 FORMAT ERROR IN G70–G73 The final move command in the blocks specified by P and Q of G70,
(T series) G71, G72, and G73 ended with chamfering or corner R.
Modify the program.
367
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
368
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
086 DR SIGNAL OFF When entering data in the memory by using Reader / Puncher interface,
the ready signal (DR) of reader / puncher was turned off.
Power supply of I/O unit is off or cable is not connected or a P.C.B. is de-
fective.
087 BUFFER OVERFLOW When entering data in the memory by using Reader / Puncher interface,
though the read terminate command is specified, input is not interrupted
after 10 characters read. I/O unit or P.C.B. is defective.
088 LAN FILE TRANS ERROR File data transfer via OSI–ETHERNET has been stopped due to a trans-
(CHANNEL–1) fer error.
089 LAN FILE TRANS ERROR File data transfer via OSI–ETHERNET has been stopped due to a trans-
(CHANNEL–2) fer error.
090 REFERENCE RETURN The reference position return cannot be performed normally because
INCOMPLETE the reference position return start point is too close to the reference posi-
tion or the speed is too slow. Separate the start point far enough from
the reference position, or specify a sufficiently fast speed for reference
position return. Check the program contents.
091 REFERENCE RETURN Manual reference position return cannot be performed when automatic
INCOMPLETE operation is halted.
092 AXES NOT ON THE REFERENCE The commanded axis by G27 (Reference position return check) did not
POINT return to the reference position.
094 P TYPE NOT ALLOWED P type cannot be specified when the program is restarted. (After the au-
(COORD CHG) tomatic operation was interrupted, the coordinate system setting opera-
tion was performed.)
Perform the correct operation according to th operator’s manual.
095 P TYPE NOT ALLOWED P type cannot be specified when the program is restarted. (After the
(EXT OFS CHG) automatic operation was interrupted, the external workpiece offset
amount changed.)
Perform the correct operation according to th operator’s manual.
096 P TYPE NOT ALLOWED P type cannot be specified when the program is restarted. (After the au-
(WRK OFS CHG) tomatic operation was interrupted, the workpiece offset amount
changed.)
Perform the correct operation according to the operator’s manual.
097 P TYPE NOT ALLOWED P type cannot be directed when the program is restarted. (After power
(AUTO EXEC) ON, after emergency stop or P / S 94 to 97 reset, no automatic operation
is performed.) Perform automatic operation.
098 G28 FOUND IN SEQUENCE A command of the program restart was specified without the reference
RETURN position return operation after power ON or emergency stop, and G28
was found during search.
Perform the reference position return.
099 MDI EXEC NOT ALLOWED After completion of search in program restart, a move command is given
AFT. SEARCH with MDI. Move axis before a move command or don’t interrupt MDI op-
eration.
100 PARAMETER WRITE ENABLE On the PARAMETER(SETTING) screen, PWE(parameter writing en-
abled) is set to 1. Set it to 0, then reset the system.
101 PLEASE CLEAR MEMORY The power turned off while rewriting the memory by program edit opera-
tion. If this alarm has occurred, press <RESET> while pressing
<PROG>, and only the program being edited will be deleted.
Register the deleted program.
109 P/S ALARM A value other than 0 or 1 was specified after P in the G08 code, or no
value was specified.
110 DATA OVERFLOW The absolute value of fixed decimal point display data exceeds the al-
lowable range. Modify the program.
369
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
111 CALCULATED DATA OVERFLOW The result of calculation turns out to be invalid, an alarm No.111 is is-
sued.
–1047 to –10–29, 0, 10–29 to 1047
Modify the program.
112 DIVIDED BY ZERO Division by zero was specified. (including tan 90°)
Modify the program.
113 IMPROPER COMMAND A function which cannot be used in custom macro is commanded.
Modify the program.
114 FORMAT ERROR IN MACRO There is an error in other formats than <Formula>.
Modify the program.
115 ILLEGAL VARIABLE NUMBER A value not defined as a variable number is designated in the custom
macro or in high–speed cycle machining.
The header contents are improper. This alarm is given in the following
cases:
High speed cycle machining
1. The header corresponding to the specified machining cycle number
called is not found.
2. The cycle connection data value is out of the allowable range
(0 – 999).
3. The number of data in the header is out of the allowable range
(0 – 32767).
4. The start data variable number of executable format data is out of
the allowable range (#20000 – #85535).
5. The last storing data variable number of executable format data is
out of the allowable range (#85535).
6. The storing start data variable number of executable format data is
overlapped with the variable number used in the header.
Modify the program.
116 WRITE PROTECTED VARIABLE The left side of substitution statement is a variable whose substitution
is inhibited. Modify the program.
118 PARENTHESIS NESTING ERROR The nesting of bracket exceeds the upper limit (quintuple).
Modify the program.
119 ILLEGAL ARGUMENT The SQRT argument is negative. Or BCD argument is negative, and
other values than 0 to 9 are present on each line of BIN argument.
Modify the program.
122 FOUR FOLD MACRO MODAL–CALL The macro modal call is specified four fold.
Modify the program.
123 CAN NOT USE MACRO COMMAND Macro control command is used during DNC operation.
IN DNC Modify the program.
124 MISSING END STATEMENT DO – END does not correspond to 1 : 1. Modify the program.
125 FORMAT ERROR IN MACRO <Formula> format is erroneous. Modify the program.
126 ILLEGAL LOOP NUMBER In DOn, 1x n x3 is not established. Modify the program.
127 NC, MACRO STATEMENT IN SAME NC and custom macro commands coexist.
BLOCK Modify the program.
128 ILLEGAL MACRO SEQUENCE The sequence number specified in the branch command was not 0 to
NUMBER 9999. Or, it cannot be searched. Modify the program.
129 ILLEGAL ARGUMENT ADDRESS An address which is not allowed in <Argument Designation > is used.
Modify the program.
130 ILLEGAL AXIS OPERATION An axis control command was given by PMC to an axis controlled by
CNC. Or an axis control command was given by CNC to an axis con-
trolled by PMC. Modify the program.
370
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
131 TOO MANY EXTERNAL ALARM Five or more alarms have generated in external alarm message.
MESSAGES Consult the PMC ladder diagram to find the cause.
132 ALARM NUMBER NOT FOUND No alarm No. concerned exists in external alarm message clear.
Check the PMC ladder diagram.
133 ILLEGAL DATA IN EXT. ALARM MSG Small section data is erroneous in external alarm message or external
operator message. Check the PMC ladder diagram.
ILLEGAL ANGLE COMMAND The index table indexing positioning angle was instructed in other than
(M series) an integral multiple of the value of the minimum angle.
135 Modify the program.
SPINDLE ORIENTATION PLEASE Without any spindle orientation , an attept was made for spindle index-
(T series) ing. Perform spindle orientation.
ILLEGAL AXIS COMMAND In index table indexing.Another control axis was instructed together with
(M series) the B axis.
136 Modify the program.
C/H–CODE & MOVE CMD IN SAME A move command of other axes was specified to the same block as
BLK. (T series) spindle indexing addresses C, H. Modify the program.
137 M–CODE & MOVE CMD IN SAME A move command of other axes was specified to the same block as M–
BLK. code related to spindle indexing. Modify the program.
138 SUPERIMPOSED DATA OVER- The total distribution amount of the CNC and PMC is too large during
FLOW superimposed control of the extended functions for PMC axis control.
139 CAN NOT CHANGE PMC CONTROL An axis is selected in commanding by PMC axis control.
AXIS Modify the program.
141 CAN NOT COMMAND G51 IN CRC G51 (Scaling ON) is commanded in the tool offset mode.
(M series) Modify the program.
142 ILLEGAL SCALE RATE Scaling magnification is commanded in other than 1 – 999999.
(M series) Correct the scaling magnification setting (G51 Pp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
or parameter 5411 or 5421).
143 SCALED MOTION DATA OVER- The scaling results, move distance, coordinate value and circular radius
FLOW exceed the maximum command value. Correct the program or scaling
(M series) mangification.
144 ILLEGAL PLANE SELECTED The coordinate rotation plane and arc or cutter compensation C plane
(M series) must be the same. Modify the program.
145 ILLEGAL CONDITIONS IN POLAR The conditions are incorrect when the polar coordinate interpolation
COORDINATE INTERPOLATION starts or it is canceled.
1) In modes other than G40, G12.1/G13.1 was specified.
2) An error is found in the plane selection. Parameters No. 5460 and
No. 5461 are incorrectly specified.
Modify the value of program or parameter.
146 IMPROPER G CODE G codes which cannot be specified in the polar coordinate interpolation
mode was specified. See section II–4.4 and modify the program.
148 ILLEGAL SETTING DATA Automatic corner override deceleration rate is out of the settable range
(M series) of judgement angle. Modify the parameters (No.1710 to No.1714)
149 FORMAT ERROR IN G10L3 A code other than Q1,Q2,P1 or P2 was specified as the life count type
(M series) in the extended tool life management.
150 ILLEGAL TOOL GROUP NUMBER Tool Group No. exceeds the maximum allowable value.
Modify the program.
151 TOOL GROUP NUMBER NOT The tool group commanded in the machining program is not set.
FOUND Modify the value of program or parameter.
152 NO SPACE FOR TOOL ENTRY The number of tools within one group exceeds the maximum value re-
gisterable. Modify the number of tools.
371
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
153 T–CODE NOT FOUND In tool life data registration, a T code was not specified where one should
be. Correct the program.
154 NOT USING TOOL IN LIFE GROUP When the group is not commanded, H99 or D99 was commanded.
(M series) Correct the program.
155 ILLEGAL T–CODE IN M06 In the machining program, M06 and T code in the same block do not cor-
(M series) respond to the group in use. Correct the program.
ILLEGAL T–CODE IN M06 Group No.∆∆ which is specified with T∆∆ 88 of the machining program
(T series) do not included in the tool group in use. Correct the program.
156 P/L COMMAND NOT FOUND P and L commands are missing at the head of program in which the tool
group is set. Correct the program.
157 TOO MANY TOOL GROUPS The number of tool groups to be set exceeds the maximum allowable
value. (See parameter No. 6800 bit 0 and 1) Modify the program.
158 ILLEGAL TOOL LIFE DATA The tool life to be set is too excessive. Modify the setting value.
159 TOOL DATA SETTING During executing a life data setting program, power was turned off.
INCOMPLETE Set again.
MISMATCH WAITING M–CODE Diffrent M code is commanded in heads 1 and 2 as waiting M code.
(T series (At two–path)) Modify the program.
160
G72.1 NESTING ERROR A subprogram which performs rotational copy with G72.1 contains
(M series) another G72.1 command.
161 G72.1 NESTING ERROR A subprogram which performs parallel copy with G72.2 contains anoth-
(M series) er G72.2 command.
COMMAND G68/G69 INDEPEN- G68 and G69 are not independently commanded in balance cut.
163
DENTLY T series (At two–path) Modify the program.
169 ILLEGAL TOOL GEOMETRY DATA Incorrect tool figure data in interference check.
(T series (At two–path)) Set correct data, or select correct tool figure data.
175 ILLEGAL G107 COMMAND Conditions when performing circular interpolation start or cancel not
correct. To change the mode to the cylindrical interpolation mode, spec-
ify the command in a format of “G07.1 rotation–axis name radius of cylin-
der.”
IMPROPER G–CODE IN G107 Any of the following G codes which cannot be specified in the cylindrical
(M series) interpolation mode was specified.
1) G codes for positioning: G28,, G73, G74, G76, G81 – G89,
including the codes specifying the rapid traverse cycle
2) G codes for setting a coordinate system: G52,G92,
3) G code for selecting coordinate system: G53 G54–G59
Modify the program.
176
IMPROPER G–CODE IN G107 Any of the following G codes which cannot be specified in the cylindrical
(T series) interpolation mode was specified.
1) G codes for positioning: G28, G76, G81 – G89, including the
codes specifying the rapid traverse cycle
2) G codes for setting a coordinate system: G50, G52
3) G code for selecting coordinate system: G53 G54–G59
Modify the program.
177 CHECK SUM ERROR Check sum error
(G05 MODE) Modify the program.
178 G05 COMMANDED IN G41/G42 G05 was commanded in the G41/G42 mode.
MODE Correct the program.
179 PARAM. (NO. 7510) SETTING The number of controlled axes set by the parameter 7510 exceeds the
ERROR maximum number. Modify the parameter setting value.
180 COMMUNICATION ERROR Remote buffer connection alarm has generated. Confirm the number of
(REMOTE BUF) cables, parameters and I/O device.
372
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
181 FORMAT ERROR IN G81 BLOCK G81 block format error (hobbing machine)
(M series) 1) T (number of teeth) has not been instructed.
2) Data outside the command range was instructed by either T, L, Q or
P.
Modify the program.
182 G81 NOT COMMANDED G83 (C axis servo lag quantity offset) was instructed though synchro-
(M series) nization by G81 has not been instructed. Correct the program. (hobbing
machine)
183 DUPLICATE G83 (COMMANDS) G83 was instructed before canceled by G82 after compensating for the
(M series) C axis servo lag quantity by G83. (hobbing machine)
184 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN G81 A command not to be instructed during synchronization by G81 was
(M series) instructed. (hobbing machine)
1) A C axis command by G00, G27, G28, G29, G30, etc. was
instructed.
2) Inch/Metric switching by G20, G21 was instructed.
185 RETURN TO REFERENCE POINT G81 was instructed without performing reference position return after
(M series) power on or emergency stop. (hobbing machine) Perform reference
position return.
186 PARAMETER SETTING ERROR Parameter error regarding G81 (hobbing machine)
(M series) 1) The C axis has not been set to be a rotary axis.
2) A hob axis and position coder gear ratio setting error
Modify the parameter.
190 ILLEGAL AXIS SELECT In the constant surface speed control, the axis specification is wrong.
(M series) (See parameter No. 3770.) The specified axis command (P) contains an
illegal value.
Correct the program.
194 SPINDLE COMMAND IN A contour control mode, spindle positioning (Cs–axis control) mode, or
SYNCHRO–MODE rigid tapping mode was specified during the serial spindle synchronous
control mode. Correct the program so that the serial spindle synchro-
nous control mode is released in advance.
195 MODE CHANGE ERROR Switching command to contouring mode, Cs axis control or rigid tap
mode or switching to spindle command mode is not correctly com-
pleted.
(This occurs when the response to switch to the spindle control unit side
with regard to the switching command from the NC is incorrect.
This alarm is not for the purposes of warning against mistakes in opera-
tion, but because continuing operation in this condition can be danger-
ous it is a P/S alarm.)
197 C–AXIS COMMANDED IN SPINDLE The program specified a movement along the Cs–axis when the signal
MODE CON(DGN=G027#7) was off. Correct the program, or consult the PMC
ladder diagram to find the reason the signal is not turned on.
199 MACRO WORD UNDEFINED Undefined macro word was used. Modify the custom macro.
200 ILLEGAL S CODE COMMAND In the rigid tap, an S value is out of the range or is not specified.
Modify the program.
201 FEEDRATE NOT FOUND IN RIGID In the rigid tap, no F value is specified.
TAP Correct the program.
202 POSITION LSI OVERFLOW In the rigid tap, spindle distribution value is too large. (System error)
203 PROGRAM MISS AT RIGID TAPPING In the rigid tap, position for a rigid M code (M29) or an S command is in-
correct. Modify the program.
373
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
204 ILLEGAL AXIS OPERATION In the rigid tap, an axis movement is specified between the rigid M code
(M29) block and G84 or G74 for M series (G84 or G88 for T series) block.
Modify the program.
205 RIGID MODE DI SIGNAL OFF Rigid mode DI signal is not ON when G84 or G74 for M series (G84 or
G88 for T series) is executed though the rigid M code (M29) is speci-
fied.Consult the PMC ladder diagram to find the reason the DI signal
(DGNG061.1) is not turned on.
206 CAN NOT CHANGE PLANE Plane changeover was instructed in the rigid mode.
(RIGID TAP) (M series) Correct the program.
210 CAN NOT COMAND M198/M199 M198 and M199 are executed in the schedule operation. M198 is
executed in the DNC operation. Modify the program.
1) The execution of an M198 or M99 command was attempted during
scheduled operation. Alternatively, the execution of an M198 com-
mand was attempted during DNC operation. Correct the program.
2) The execution of an M99 command was attempted by an interrupt
macro during pocket machining in a multiple repetitive canned
cycle.
211 G31 (HIGH) NOT ALLOWED IN G99 G31 is commanded in the per revolution command when the high–
speed skip option is provided. Modify the program.
ILLEGAL PLANE SELECT The arbitrary angle chamfering or a corner R is commanded or the plane
(M series) including an additional axis. Correct the program.
212
ILLEGAL PLANE SELECT The direct drawing dimensions programming is commanded for the
(T series) plane other than the Z–X plane. Correct the program.
213 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN Movement is commanded for the axis to be synchronously controlled.
SYNCHRO–MODE Any of the following alarms occurred in the operation with the simple
synchronization control.
1) The program issued the move command to the slave axis.
2) The program issued the manual continuous feed/manual handle
feed/incremental feed command to the slave axis.
3) The program issued the automatic reference position return com-
mand without specifying the manual reference position return after
the power was turned on.
4) The difference between the position error amount of the master and
slave axes exceeded the value specified in parameter NO.8313.
ILLEGAL COMMAND IN A move command has been specified for an axis subject to synchro-
SYNCHRO–MODE (T series) nous control.
214 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN Coordinate system is set or tool compensation of the shift type is
SYNCHRO–MODE executed in the synchronous control. Correct the program.
217 DUPLICATE G51.2 (COMMANDS) G51.2/G251 is further commanded in the G51.2/G251 mode. Modify
(T series) the program.
218 NOT FOUND P/Q COMMAND IN P or Q is not commanded in the G251 block, or the command value is
G251 (T series) out of the range. Modify the program.
219 COMMAND G250/G251 G251 and G250 are not independent blocks.
INDEPENDENTLY (T series)
220 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN In the synchronous operation, movement is commanded by the NC pro-
SYNCHR–MODE (T series) gram or PMC axis control interface for the synchronous axis.
221 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN Polygon machining synchronous operation and axis control or balance
SYNCHR–MODE (T series) cutting are executed at a time. Modify the program.
222 DNC OP. NOT ALLOWED IN Input and output are executed at a time in the background edition.
BG.–EDIT (M series) Execute a correct operation.
374
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
224 RETURN TO REFERENCE POINT Reference position return has not been performed before the automatic
(M series) operation starts. Perform reference position return only when bit 0 of pa-
rameter 1005 is 0.
TURN TO REFERENCE POINT Reference position return is necessary before cycle start.
(T series)
225 SYNCHRONOUS/MIXED CONTROL This alarm is generated in the following circumstances. (Searched for
ERROR during synchronous and mixed control command.
T series (At two–path) 1 When there is a mistake in axis number parameter setting.
2 When there is a mistake in control commanded.
Modify the program or the parameter.
226 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN SYNCHRO– A travel command has been sent to the axis being synchronized in syn-
MODE T series (At two–path) chronous mode. Modify the program or the parameter.
229 CAN NOT KEEP SYNCHRO–STATE This alarm is generated in the following circumstances.
(T series) 1 When the synchro/mixed state could not be kept due to system over-
load.
2 The above condition occurred in CMC devices (hardware) and syn-
chro–state could not be kept.
(This alarm is not generated in normal use conditions.)
230 R CODE NOT FOUND The infeed quantity R has not been instructed for the G161 block. Or
(GS series) the R command value is negative. Correct the program.
231 ILLEGAL FORMAT IN G10 OR L50 Any of the following errors occurred in the specified format at the pro-
grammable–parameter input.
1 Address N or R was not entered.
2 A number not specified for a parameter was entered.
3 The axis number was too large.
4 An axis number was not specified in the axis–type parameter.
5 An axis number was specified in the parameter which is not an axis
type. Correct the program.
6 An attempt was made to reset bit 4 of parameter 3202 (NE9) or
change parameter 3210 (PSSWD) when they are protected by a
password. Correct the program.
232 TOO MANY HELICAL AXIS Three or more axes (in the normal direction control mode two or more
COMMANDS (M series) axes) were specified as helical axes in the helical interpolation mode.
233 DEVICE BUSY When an attempt was made to use a unit such as that connected via the
RS–232–C interface, other users were using it.
239 BP/S ALARM While punching was being performed with the function for controlling ex-
ternal I/O units ,background editing was performed.
240 BP/S ALARM Background editing was performed during MDI operation.
241 ILLEGAL FORMAT IN G02.2/G03.2 The end point, I, J, K, or R is missing from a command for involute inter-
(M series) polation.
242 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN An invalid value has been specified for involute interpolation.
G02.2/G03.2 S The start or end point is within the basic circle.
(M series)
S I, J, K, or R is set to 0.
S The number of rotations between the start of the involute curve and
the start or end point exceeds 100.
243 OVER TOLERANCE OF END POINT The end point is not on the involute curve which includes the start point
(M series) and thus falls outside the range specified with parameter No. 5610.
375
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
244 P/S ALARM In the skip function activated by the torque limit signal, the number of ac-
(T series) cumulated erroneous pulses exceed 32767 before the signal was input.
Therefore, the pulses cannot be corrected with one distribution.
Change the conditions, such as feed rates along axes and torque limit,
and try again.
245 T–CODE NOT ALOWEE IN THIS One of the G codes, G50, G10, and G04, which cannot be specified in
BLOCK (T series) the same block as a T code, was specified with a T code.
250 Z AXIS WRONG COMMAND (ATC) A value for the Z–axis has been specified in a block for the tool ex-
(M series) change command (M06T_) on a system with DRILL–MATE ARC
installed.
251 ATC ERROR This alarm is issued in the following cases (DRILL–MATE):
(M series) S An M06T_ command contains an unusable T code.
S An M06 command has been specified when the Z machine coordi
nate is positive.
S The parameter for the current tool number (No. 7810) is set to 0.
S An M06 command has been specified in canned cycle mode.
S A reference position return command (G27 to G44) and M06 com-
mand have been specified in the same block.
S An M06 command has been specified in tool compensation mode
(G41 to G44).
S An M06 command has been specified without performing reference
position return after power–on or the release of emergency stop.
S The machine lock signal or Z–axis ignore signal has been turned on
during tool exchange.
S A pry alarm has been detected during tool exchange.
Refer to diagnosis No. 530 to determine the cause.
252 ATC SPINDLE ALARM An excessive error arose during spindle positioning for ATC. For details,
(M series) refer to diagnosis No. 531. (Only for DRILL–MATE)
253 G05 IS NOT AVAILABLE Alarm details
(M series) Binary input operation using high–speed remote buffer (G05) or high–
speed cycle machining (G05) has been specified in advance control
mode (G08P1). Execute G08P0; to cancel advance control mode, be-
fore executing these G05 commands.
4500 REPOSITIONING INHIBITED A repositioning command was specified in the circular interpolation
(G02, G03) mode.
4502 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN BOLT In a bolt hole circle (G26) command, the radius (I) was set to zero or a
HOLE negative value, or the number of holes (K) was set to zero. Alternatively,
I, J, or K was not specified.
4503 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN LINE AT In a line-at-angle (G76) command, the number of holes (K) was set to
ANGLE zero or a negative value. Alternatively, I, J, or K was not specified.
4504 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN ARC In an arc (G77) command, the radius (I) or the number of holes (K) was
set to zero or a negative value. Alternatively, I, J, K, or P was not speci-
fied.
4505 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN GRID In a grid (G78, G79) command, the number of holes (P, K) was set to
zero or a negative value. Alternatively, I, J, K, or P was not specified.
4506 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN SHARE In a shear proof (G86) command, the tool size (P) was set to zero, or the
PROOFS blanking length (I) was 1.5 times larger than the tool size (P) or less. Al-
ternatively, I, J, or P was not specified.
4507 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN SQUARE In a square (G87) command, the tool size (P,Q) was set to zero or a neg-
ative value, or the blanking length (I, J) was three times larger than the
tool size (P, Q) or less. Alternatively, I, J, P, or Q was not specified.
376
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
4508 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN RADIUS In a radius (G88) command, the traveling pitch (Q) or radius (I) was set
to zero or a negative value, or the traveling pitch (Q) was greater than
or equal to the arc length. Alternatively, I, J, K, P, or Q was not specified.
4509 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN CUT AT In a cut-at-angle (G89) command, the traveling pitch (Q) was set to zero,
ANGLE negative value, or another value larger than or equal to the length (I).
Alternatively, I, J, P, or Q was not specified.
4510 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN In a linear punching (G45) command, the traveling distance was set to
LINE-PUNCH zero or a value 1.5 times larger than the tool size (P) or less. Alternative-
ly, P was not specified.
4511 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN In a circular punching (G46, G47) command, the same position was
CIRCLE-PUNCH specified for both start and end points of the arc, radius (R) of the arc was
set to zero, or the pitch (Q) was set to a value exceeding the arc length.
Alternatively, R or Q was not specified.
4520 T, M INHIBITED IN T code, M code, G04, G70 or G75 was specified in the nibbling mode.
NIBBLING-MODE
4521 EXCESS NIBBLING MOVEMENT In the nibbling mode, the X-axis or Y-axis traveling distance was larger
(X, Y) than or equal to the limit (No. 16188 to 16193).
4522 EXCESS NIBBLING MOVEMENT In the circular nibbling (G68) or usual nibbling mode, the C-axis traveling
(C) distance was larger than or equal to the limit (No. 16194).
4523 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN In a circular nibbling (G68) command, the traveling pitch (Q) was set to
CIRCLE-NIBBL zero, a negative value, or a value larger than or equal to the limit (No.
16186, 16187), or the radius (I) was set to zero or a negative value. Al-
ternatively, I, J, K, P, or Q was not specified.
4524 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN In a linear nibbling (G69) command, the traveling pitch (Q) was set to
LINE-NIBBL zero, negative value, or a value larger than or equal to the limit (No.
16186, 16187). Alternatively, I, J, P, or Q was not specified.
4530 A/B MACRO NUMBER ERROR The number for storing and calling by an A or B macro was set to a value
beyond the range from 1 to 5.
4531 U/V MACRO FORMAT ERROR An attempt was made to store a macro while storing another macro us-
ing a U or V macro.
A V macro was specified although the processing to store a macro was
not in progress.
A U macro number and V macro number do not correspond with each
other.
4532 IMPROPER U/V MACRO NUMBER The number of an inhibited macro (number beyond the range from 01
to 99) was specified in a U or V macro command.
4533 U/V MACRO MEMORY OVERFLOW An attempt was made to store too many macros with a U or V macro
command.
4534 W MACRO NUMBER NOT FOUND Macro number W specified in a U or V macro command is not stored.
4535 U/V MACRO NESTING ERROR An attempt was made to call a macro which is defined three times or
more using a U or V macro command.
An attempt was made to store 15 or more macros in the storage area
for macros of number 90 to 99.
4536 NO W, Q COMMAND IN W or Q was not specified in the command for taking multiple workpieces
MULTI-PIECE (G73, G74).
4537 ILLEGAL Q VALUE IN MULTI-PIECE In the command for taking multiple workpieces (G73, G74), Q is set to
a value beyond the range from 1 to 4.
4538 W NO. NOT FOUND IN Macro number W specified in the command for taking multiple work-
MULTI-PIECE pieces (G73, G74) is not stored.
377
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
4539 MULTI-PIECE SETTING IS ZERO The command for taking multiple workpieces (G73, G74) was specified
although zero is specified for the function to take multiple workpieces
(No. 16206 or signals MLP1 and MLP2 (PMC address G231, #0 and
#1)).
4540 MULTI-PIECE COMMAND WITHIN The command for taking multiple workpieces (G73, G74) was specified
MACRO when a U or V macro was being stored.
4542 MULTI-PIECE COMMAND ERROR Although G98P0 was specified, the G73 command was issued.
Although G98K0 was specified, the G74 command was issued.
4543 MULTI-PIECE Q COMMAND Although G98P0 was specified, the Q value for the G74 command was
ERROR not 1 or 3.
Although G98K0 was specified, the Q value for the G73 command was
not 1 or 2.
4544 MULTI-PIECE RESTART ERROR In the command for resuming taking multiple workpieces, the resume
position (P) is set to a value beyond the range from 1 to total number of
workpieces to be machined.
4549 ILLEGAL TOOL DATA FORMAT The quantity of tool data patterns to be saved is too large to fit the usable
area (16 KB).
4600 T, C COMMAND IN In the linear interpolation (G01) mode or circular interpolation (G02,
INTERPOLATION G03) mode, a T command or C-axis command was specified.
4601 INHIBITED T, M COMMAND In the block of G52, G72, G73, or G74, a T or M command was specified.
4602 ILLEGAL T-CODE The specified T command is not cataloged on the tool register screen.
4603 C AXIS SYNCHRONOUS ERROR The difference between the position deviation value of C1 axis and C2
axis exceeds the parameter value (No. 16364, 16365) with the C–axis
synchronous control function.
4604 ILLEGAL AXIS OPERATION A C-axis command was specified in the block containing a T command
for multiple tools.
4630 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN LASER In the laser mode, a nibbling command or pattern command was speci-
MODE fied.
In the tracing mode, an attempt was made to make a switch to the
punching mode.
4631 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN PUNCH In the punching mode, a G code of laser control (G13, G24, G31, etc.)
MODE was specified.
4650 IMPROPER G-CODE IN OFFSET In the cutter compensation mode, an inhibited G code (pattern com-
MODE mand, G73, G74, G75, etc.) was specified.
4700 PROGRAM ERROR (OT +) The value specified in the X-axis move command exceeded the positive
value of stored stroke limit 1. (Advance check)
4701 PROGRAM ERROR (OT –) The value specified in the X-axis move command exceeded the nega-
tive value of stored stroke limit 1. (Advance check)
4702 PROGRAM ERROR (OT +) The value specified in the Y-axis move command exceeded the positive
value of stored stroke limit 1. (Advance check)
4703 PROGRAM ERROR (OT –) The value specified in the Y-axis move command exceeded the nega-
tive value of stored stroke limit 1. (Advance check)
4704 PROGRAM ERROR (OT +) The value specified in the Z-axis move command exceeded the positive
value of stored stroke limit 1. (Advance check)
4705 PROGRAM ERROR (OT –) The value specified in the Z-axis move command exceeded the nega-
tive value of stored stroke limit 1. (Advance check)
5000 ILLEGAL COMMAND CODE The specified code was incorrect in the high–precision contour control
(M series) (HPCC) mode.
5003 ILLEGAL PARAMETER (HPCC) There is an invalid parameter.
(M series)
378
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
5004 HPCC NOT READY (M series) High–precision contour control is not ready.
5006 TOO MANY WORD IN ONE BLOCK The number of words specified in a block exceeded 26 in the HPCC
(M series) mode.
5007 TOO LARGE DISTANCE (M series) In the HPCC mode, the machine moved beyond the limit.
5009 PARAMETER ZERO (DRY RUN) The maximum feedrate (parameter No. 1422) or the feedrate in dry run
(M series) (parameter No. 1410) is 0 in the HPCC model.
5010 END OF RECORD The end of record (%) was specified.
I/O is incorrect. modify the program.
5011 PARAMETER ZERO(CUT MAX) The maximum cutting feedrate (parameter No. 1422)is 0 in the HPCC
(M series) mode.
5012 G05 P10000 ILLEGAL START UP Function category:
(HPCC) High–precision contour control
(M series) Alarm details:
G05 P10000 has been specified in a mode from which the system can-
not enter HPCC mode.
5013 HPCC: CRC OFS REMAIN AT CAN- G05P0 has been specified in G41/G42 mode or with offset remaining.
CEL (M series)
5014 TRACE DATA NOT FOUND Transfer cannot be performed because no trace data exists.
(M series)
5015 The specified rotation axis does not exist for tool axis direction handle
(M series) feed.
5016 ILLEGAL COMBINATION OF M M codes which belonged to the same group were specified in a block.
CODE Alternatively,an M code which must be specified without other M codes
in the block was specified in a block with other M codes.
5018 POLYGON SPINDLE SPEED ER- Function category:
ROR Polygon turning
(T series) Alarm details:
In G51.2 mode, the speed of the spindle or polygon synchronous axis
either exceeds the clamp value or is too small. The specified rotation
speed ratio thus cannot be maintained.
5020 PARAMETER OF RESTART ERROR An erroneous parameter was specified for restarting a program.
A parameter for program restart is invalid.
5030 ILLEGAL COMMAND (G100) The end command (G110) was specified before the registratioin start
(T series) command (G101, G102, or G103) was specified for the B–axis.
5031 ILLEGAL COMMAND (G100, G102, While a registration start command (G101, G102, or G103) was being
G103) (T series) executed, another registration start command was specified for the B–
axis.
5032 NEW PRG REGISTERED IN B–AXS While the machine was moving about the B–axis, at attempt was made
MOVE (T series) to register another move command.
5033 NO PROG SPACE IN MEMORY B– Commands for movement about the B–axis were not registered be-
AXS (T series) cause of insufficient program memory.
5034 PLURAL COMMAND IN G110 Multiple movements were specified with the G110 code for the B–axis.
(T series)
5035 NO FEEDRATE COMMANDED B– A feedrate was not specified for cutting feed about the B–axis.
AXS (T series)
5036 ADDRESS R NOT DEFINED IN Point R was not specified for the canned cycle for the B–axis.
G81–G86 (T series)
5037 ADDRESS Q NOT DEFINED IN G83 Depth of cut Q was not specified for the G83 code (peck drilling cycle).
(T series) Alternatively, 0 was specified in Q for the B–axis.
5038 TOO MANY START M–CODE COM- More than six M codes for starting movement about the B–axis were
MAND (T series) specified.
379
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
5039 START UNREGISTERED B–AXS An attempt was made to execute a program for the B–axis which had
PROG (T series) not been registered.
5040 CAN NOT COMMANDED B–AXS The machine could not move about the B–axis because parameter
MOVE (T series) No.8250 was incorrectly specified, or because the PMC axis system
could not be used.
5041 CAN NOT COMMANDED G110 Blocks containing the G110 codes were successively specified in tool–
BLOCK (T series) tip radius compensation for the B–axis.
5043 TOO MANY G68 NESTING Three–dimensional coordinate conversion G68 has been specified
(M series) three or more times.
5044 G68 FORMAT ERROR A G68 command block contains a format error. This alarm is issued in
(M series) the following cases:
1. I, J, or K is missing from a G68 command block (missing coordinate
rotation option).
2. I, J, and K are 0 in a G68 command block.
3. R is missing from a G68 command block.
5046 ILLEGAL PARAMETER (ST.COMP) The parameter settings for straightness compensation contain an error.
Possible causes are as follows:
1. A parameter for a movement axis or compensation axis contains an
axis number which is not used.
2. More than 128 pitch error compensation points exist between the
negative and positive end points.
3. Compensation point numbers for straightness compensation are
not assigned in the correct order.
4. No straightness compensation point exists between the pitch error
compensation points at the negative and positive ends.
5. The compensation value for each compensation point is too large
or too small.
5050 ILL–COMMAND IN CHOPPING A command for switching the major axis has been specified for circular
MODE threading. Alternatively, a command for setting the length of the major
(M series) axis to 0 has been specified for circular threading.
5051 M–NET CODE ERROR Abnormal character received (other than code used for transmission)
5052 M–NET ETX ERROR Abnormal ETX code
5053 M–NET CONNECT ERROR Connection time monitoring error (parameter No. 175)
5054 M–NET RECEIVE ERROR Polling time monitoring error (parameter No. 176)
5055 M–NET PRT/FRT ERROR Vertical parity or framing error
5057 M–NET BOARD SYSTEM DOWN Transmission timeout error (parameter No. 177)
ROM parity error
CPU interrupt other than the above
5058 G35/G36 FORMAT ERROR A command for switching the major axis has been specified for circular
(T series) threading. Alternatively, a command for setting the length of the major
axis to 0 has been specified for circular threading.
5059 RADIUS IS OUT OF RANGE A radius exceeding nine digits has been specified for circular interpola-
(T series) tion with the center of the arc specified with I, J, and K.
380
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
381
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
NOTE
HPCC : High precision contour control
5138 FSSB : AXIS SETTING NOT COM- In automatic setting mode, axis setting has not been made yet.
PLETE Perform axis setting on the FSSB setting screen.
5156 ILLEGAL AXIS OPERATION In simple high–precision contour control mode, the controlled axis
(SHPCC) selection signal (PMC axis control) changes.
(M series) In simple high–precision contour control mode, the simple synchronous
axis selection signal changes.
5197 FSSB : OPEN TIME OUT The CNC permitted FSSB to open, but FSSB was not opened.
5198 FSSB : ID DATA NOT READ Temporary assignment failed, so amplifier initial ID information could not
be read.
382
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
NOTE
SHPCC stands for simple high–precision contour control.
??? BP/S alarm BP/S alarm occurs in the same number as the P/S alarm that occurs in
ordinary program edit. (070, 071, 072, 073, 074 085,086,087 etc.)
140 BP/S alarm It was attempted to select or delete in the background a program being
selected in the foreground. (Note)
Use background editing correctly.
NOTE
Alarm in background edit is displayed in the key input line of the background edit screen instead
of the ordinary alarm screen and is resettable by any of the MDI key operation.
300 nth–axis origin return Manual reference position return is required for the nth–axis (n=1 – 8).
301 APC alarm: nth–axis communication nth–axis (n=1 – 8) APC communication error. Failure in data transmis-
sion
Possible causes include a faulty APC, cable, or servo interface module.
302 APC alarm: nth–axis over time nth–axis (n=1 – 8) APC overtime error.
Failure in data transmission.
Possible causes include a faulty APC, cable, or servo interface module.
303 APC alarm: nth–axis framing nth–axis (n=1 – 8) APC framing error. Failure in data transmission.
Possible causes include a faulty APC, cable, or servo interface module.
304 APC alarm: nth–axis parity nth–axis (n=1 – 8) APC parity error.
Failure in data transmission.
Possible causes include a faulty APC, cable, or servo interface module.
305 APC alarm: nth–axis pulse error nth–axis (n=1 – 8) APC pulse error alarm.
APC alarm.APC or cable may be faulty.
306 APC alarm: nth–axis battery nth–axis (n=1 – 8) APC battery voltage has decreased to a low level so
voltage 0 that the data cannot be held.
APC alarm. Battery or cable may be faulty.
307 APC alarm: nth–axis battery low 1 nth–axis (n=1 – 8) axis APC battery voltage reaches a level where the
battery must be renewed.
APC alarm. Replace the battery.
308 APC alarm: nth–axis battery low 2 nth–axis (n=1 – 8) APC battery voltage has reached a level where the
battery must be renewed (including when power is OFF).
APC alarm .Replace battery.
309 APC ALARM: Return to the origin has been attempted without first rotating the motor
n AXIS ZRN IMPOSSIBL one or more times. Before returning to the origin, rotate the motor one
or more times then turn off the power.
383
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
360 n AXIS : ABNORMAL CHECKSUM A checksum error occurred in the built–in pulse coder.
(INT)
361 n AXIS : ABNORMAL PHASE DATA A phase data error occurred in the built–in pulse coder.
(INT)
362 n AXIS : ABNORMAL REV.DATA A rotation speed count error occurred in the built–in pulse coder.
(INT)
363 n AXIS : ABNORMAL CLOCK (INT) A clock error occurred in the built–in pulse coder.
364 n AXIS : SOFT PHASE ALARM (INT) The digital servo software detected invalid data in the built–in pulse
coder.
365 n AXIS : BROKEN LED (INT) An LED error occurred in the built–in pulse coder.
366 n AXIS : PULSE MISS (INT) A pulse error occurred in the built–in pulse coder.
367 n AXIS : COUNT MISS (INT) A count error occurred in the built–in pulse coder.
368 n AXIS : SERIAL DATA ERROR Communication data from the built–in pulse coder cannot be re-
(INT) ceived.
369 n AXIS : DATA TRANS. ERROR A CRC or stop bit error occurred in the communication data being
(INT) received from the built–in pulse coder.
380 n AXIS : BROKEN LED (EXT) The separate detector is erroneous.
381 n AXIS : ABNORMAL PHASE A phase data error occurred in the separate linear scale.
(EXT LIN)
382 n AXIS : COUNT MISS (EXT) A pulse error occurred in the separate detector.
383 n AXIS : PULSE MISS (EXT) A count error occurred in the separate detector.
384 n AXIS : SOFT PHASE ALARM The digital servo software detected invalid data in the separate de-
(EXT) tector.
385 n AXIS : SERIAL DATA ERROR Communication data from the separate detector cannot be received.
(EXT)
386 n AXIS : DATA TRANS. ERROR A CRC or stop bit error occurred in the communication data being
(EXT) received from the separate detector.
384
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
203 DTE CRC STB PRM
401 SERVO ALARM: n–TH AXIS VRDY The n–th axis (axis 1–8) servo amplifier READY signal (DRDY) went off.
OFF Refer to procedure of trouble shooting.
404 SERVO ALARM: n–TH AXIS VRDY Even though the n–th axis (axis 1–8) READY signal (MCON) went off,
ON the servo amplifier READY signal (DRDY) is still on. Or, when the power
was turned on, DRDY went on even though MCON was off.
Check that the servo interface module and servo amp are connected.
405 SERVO ALARM: (ZERO POINT RE- Position control system fault. Due to an NC or servo system fault in the
TURN FAULT) reference position return, there is the possibility that reference position
return could not be executed correctly. Try again from the manual refer-
ence position return.
407 SERVO ALARM: EXCESS ERROR The difference in synchronous axis position deviation exceeded the set
value.
409 SERVO ALARM: n AXIS TORQUE Abnormal servo motor load has been detected. Alternatively, abnormal
ALM spindle motor load has been detected in Cs mode.
410 SERVO ALARM: n–TH AXIS – EX- The position deviation value when the n–th axis (axis 1–8) stops is larg-
CESS ERROR er than the set value.
Refer to procedure of trouble shooting.
411 SERVO ALARM: n–TH AXIS – EX- The position deviation value when the n–th axis (axis 1–8) moves is
CESS ERROR larger than the set value.
Refer to procedure of trouble shooting.
413 SERVO ALARM: n–th AXIS – LSI The contents of the error register for the n–th axis (axis 1–8) exceeded
OVERFLOW "231 power. This error usually occurs as the result of an improperly set
parameters.
415 SERVO ALARM: n–TH AXIS – EX- A speed higher than 511875 units/s was attempted to be set in the n–th
CESS SHIFT axis (axis 1–8). This error occurs as the result of improperly set CMR.
417 SERVO ALARM: n–TH AXIS – PA- This alarm occurs when the n–th axis (axis 1–8) is in one of the condi-
RAMETER INCORRECT tions listed below. (Digital servo system alarm)
1) The value set in Parameter No. 2020 (motor form) is out of the speci-
fied limit.
2) A proper value (111 or –111) is not set in parameter No.2022 (motor
revolution direction).
3) Illegal data (a value below 0, etc.) was set in parameter No. 2023
(number of speed feedback pulses per motor revolution).
4) Illegal data (a value below 0, etc.) was set in parameter No. 2024
(number of position feedback pulses per motor revolution).
5) Parameters No. 2084 and No. 2085 (flexible field gear rate) have not
been set.
6) A value outside the limit of {1 to the number of control axes} or a non–
continuous value (Parameter 1023 (servo axis number) contains a
value out of the range from 1 to the number of axes, or an isolated
value (for example, 4 not prceded by 3).was set in parameter No.
1023 (servo axisnumber).
385
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
420 SERVO ALARM: n AXIS SYNC During simple synchronous control, the difference between the torque
TORQUE commands for the master and slave axes exceeded the value set in pa-
(M series) rameter No. 2031.
421 SERVO ALARM: n AXIS EXCESS The difference between the errors in the semi–closed loop and closed
ER (D) loop has become excessive during dual position feedback. Check the
values of the dual position conversion coefficients in parameters No.
2078 and 2079.
422 SERVO ALARM: n AXIS In torque control of PMC axis control, a specified allowable speed
has been exceeded.
423 SERVO ALARM: n AXIS In torque control of PMC axis control, the parameter–set allowable
cumulative travel distance has been exceeded.
430 n AXIS : SV. MOTOR OVERHEAT A servo motor overheat occurred.
431 n AXIS : CNV. OVERLOAD 1) PSM: Overheat occurred.
2) β series SVU: Overheat occurred.
432 n AXIS : CNV. LOWVOLT CON./ 1) PSM: Phase missing occurred in the input voltage.
POWFAULT 2) PSMR: The control power supply voltage has dropped.
3) α series SVU: The control power supply voltage has dropped.
433 n AXIS : CNV. LOW VOLT DC LINK 1) PSM: The DC link voltage has dropped.
2) PSMR: The DC link voltage has dropped.
3) α series SVU: The DC link voltage has dropped.
4) β series SVU: The DC link voltage has dropped.
434 n AXIS : INV. LOW VOLT CONTROL SVM: The control power supply voltage has dropped.
435 n AXIS : INV. LOW VOLT DC LINK SVM: The DC link voltage has dropped.
436 n AXIS : SOFTTHERMAL (OVC) The digital servo software detected the soft thermal state (OVC).
437 n AXIS : CNV. OVERCURRENT PSM: Overcurrent flowed into the input circuit.
POWER
438 n AXIS : INV. ABNORMAL CUR- 1) SVM: The motor current is too high.
RENT 2) α series SVU: The motor current is too high.
3) β series SVU: The motor current is too high.
439 n AXIS : CNV. OVERVOLT POWER 1) PSM: The DC link voltage is too high.
2) PSMR: The DC link voltage is too high.
3) α series SVU: The C link voltage is too high.
4) β series SVU: The link voltage is too high.
440 n AXIS : CNV. EX DECELERATION 1) PSMR: The regenerative discharge amount is too large.
POW. 2) α series SVU: The regenerative discharge amount is too large. Al-
ternatively, the regenerative discharge circuit is abnormal.
441 n AXIS : ABNORMAL CURRENT The digital servo software detected an abnormality in the motor cur-
OFFSET rent detection circuit.
442 n AXIS : CNV. CHARGE FAULT/INV. 1) PSM: The spare discharge circuit of the DC link is abnormal.
DB 2) PSMR: The spare discharge circuit of the DC link is abnormal.
3) α series SVU: The dynamic brake circuit is abnormal.
443 n AXIS : CNV. COOLING FAN FAIL- 1) PSM: The internal stirring fan failed.
URE 2) PSMR: The internal stirring fan failed.
3) β series SVU: The internal stirring fan failed.
444 n AXIS : INV. COOLING FAN FAIL- SVM: The internal stirring fan failed.
URE
386
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
445 n AXIS : SOFT DISCONNECT The digital servo software detected a broken wire in the pulse coder.
ALARM
446 n AXIS : HARD DISCONNECT A broken wire in the built–in pulse coder was detected by hardware.
ALARM
447 n AXIS : HARD DISCONNECT (EXT) A broken wire in the separate detector was detected by hardware.
448 n AXIS : UNMATCHED FEEDBACK The sign of feedback data from the built–in pulse coder differs from
ALARM that of feedback data from the separate detector.
449 n AXIS : INV. IPM ALARM 1) SVM: IPM (intelligent power module) detected an alarm.
2) α series SVU: IPM (intelligent power module) detected an alarm.
460 n AXIS : FSSB DISCONNECT FSSB communication was disconnected suddenly. The possible
causes are as follows:
1) The FSSB communication cable was disconnected or broken.
2) The power to the amplifier was turned off suddenly.
3) A low–voltage alarm was issued by the amplifier.
461 n AXIS : ILLEGAL AMP INTERFACE The axes of the 2–axis amplifier were assigned to the fast type inter-
face.
462 n AXIS : SEND CNC DATA FAILED Because of an FSSB communication error, a slave could not receive
correct data.
463 n AXIS : SEND SLAVE DATA Because of an FSSB communication error, the servo system could
FAILED not receive correct data.
464 n AXIS : WRITE ID DATA FAILED An attempt was made to write maintenance information on the ampli-
fier maintenance screen, but it failed.
465 n AXIS : READ ID DATA FAILED At power–up, amplifier initial ID information could not be read.
466 n AXIS : MOTOR/AMP COMBINA- The maximum current rating for the amplifier does not match that for
TION the motor.
467 n AXIS : ILLEGAL SETTING OF The servo function for the following has not been enabled when an
AXIS axis occupying a single DSP (corresponding to two ordinary axes) is
specified on the axis setting screen.
1. Learning control (bit 5 of parameter No. 2008 = 1)
2. High–speed current loop (bit 0 of parameter No. 2004 = 1)
3. High–speed interface axis (bit 4 of parameter No. 2005 = 1)
D Details of servo alarm The details of servo alarm are displayed in the diagnosis display (No. 200
and No.204) as shown below.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
200 OVL LV OVC HCA HVA DCA FBA OFA
387
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
201 ALD EXP
When OVL equal 1 in diagnostic data No.200 (servo alarm No. 400 is
being generated):
When FBAL equal 1 in diagnostic data No.200 (servo alarm No. 416 is
being generated):
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
204 OFS MCC LDA PMS
500 OVER TRAVEL : +n Exceeded the n–th axis (axis 1–8) + side stored stroke limit I.
(Parameter No.1320 or 1326 NOTE)
501 OVER TRAVEL : –n Exceeded the n–th axis (axis 1–8) – side stored stroke limit I.
(Parameter No.1321 or 1327 NOTE)
502 OVER TRAVEL : +n Exceeded the n–th axis (axis 1–8) + side stored stroke limit II.
(Parameter No.1322 )
503 OVER TRAVEL : –n Exceeded the n–th axis (axis 1–8) – side stored stroke limit II.
(Parameter No.1323)
504 OVER TRAVEL : +n Exceeded the n–th axis (axis 1–8) + side stored stroke limit III.
(Parameter No.1324 )
505 OVER TRAVEL : –n Exceeded the n–th axis (axis 1–8) – side stored stroke limit III.
(Parameter No.1325 )
506 OVER TRAVEL : +n Exceeded the n–th axis (axis 1–8) + side hardware OT.
507 OVER TRAVEL : –n Exceeded the n–th axis (axis 1–8) – side hardware OT.
508 INTERFERENCE: +n A tool moving in the positive direction along the n axis has fouled anoth-
(T series (two–path control)) er tool post.
509 INTERFERENCE: –n A tool moving in the negative direction along the n axis has fouled anoth-
(T series (two–path control)) er tool post.
388
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
510 OVER TRAVEL: +n Alarm for stroke check prior to movement. The end point specified in a
block falls within the forbidden area defined with the stroke limit in the
positive direction along the N axis. Correct the program.
511 OVER TRAVEL: –n Alarm for stroke check prior to movement. The end point specified in a
block falls within the forbidden area defined with the stroke limit in the
negative direction along the N axis. Correct the program.
NOTE
Parameters 1326 and 1327 are effective when EXLM(stroke limit switch signal) is on.
740 RIGID TAP ALARM: EXCESS ER- The positional deviation of the stopped spindle has exceeded the set
ROR value during rigid tapping.
741 RIGID TAP ALARM: EXCESS ER- The positional deviation of the moving spindle has exceeded the set val-
ROR ue during rigid tapping.
742 RIGID TAP ALARM: LSI OVER- An LSI overflow has occurred for the spindle during rigid tapping.
FLOW
389
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
749 S–SPINDLE LSI ERROR It is serial communication error while system is executing after power
supply on. Following reasons can be considered.
1) Optical cable connection is fault or cable is not connected or cable
is cut.
2) MAIN CPU board or option 2 board is fault.
3) Spindle amp. printed board is fault.
If this alarm occurs when CNC power supply is turned on or when
this alarm can not be cleared even if CNC is reset, turn off the power
supply also turn off the power supply in spindle side.
750 SPINDLE SERIAL LINK START This alarm is generated when the spindle control unit is not ready for
FAULT starting correctly when the power is turned on in the system with the
serial spindle.
The four reasons can be considered as follows:
1) An improperly connected optic cable, or the spindle control unit’s
power is OFF.
2) When the NC power was turned on under alarm conditions other
than SU–01 or AL–24 which are shown on the LED display of the
spindle control unit.
In this case, turn the spindle amplifier power off once and perform
startup again.
3) Other reasons (improper combination of hardware)
This alarm does not occur after the system including the spindle con-
trol unit is activated.
4) The second spindle (when SP2, bit 4 of parameter No. 3701, is 1)
is in one of the above conditions 1) to 3).
See diagnostic display No. 409 for details.
751 FIRST SPINDLE ALARM This alarm indicates in the NC that an alarm is generated in the spindle
DETECTION (AL–XX) unit of the system with the serial spindle. The alarm is displayed in form
AL–XX (XX is a number). Refer to B.3 or B.4 Alarms displayed on
spindle servo unit .The alarm number XX is the number indicated on
the spindle amplifier. The CNC holds this number and displays on the
screen.
752 FIRST SPINDLE MODE CHANGE This alarm is generated if the system does not properly terminate a
FAULT mode change. The modes include the Cs contouring, spindle position-
ing, rigid tapping, and spindle control modes. The alarm is activated if
the spindle control unit does not respond correctly to the mode change
command issued by the NC.
754 SPINDLE–1 ABNORMAL TORQUE Abnormal first spindle motor load has been detected.
ALM
761 SECOND SPINDLE ALARM Refer to alarm No. 751. (For 2nd axis)
DETECTION (AL–XX)
762 SECOND SPINDLE MODE Refer to alarm No. 752.(For 2nd axis)
CHANGE FAULT
764 SPINDLE–2 ABNORMAL TORQUE Same as alarm No. 754 (for the second spindle)
ALM
771 SPINDLE–3 ALARM DETECT Same as alarm No. 751 (for the third spindle)
(AL–XX)
772 SPINDLE–3 MODE CHANGE EROR Same as alarm No. 752 (for the third spindle)
774 SPINDLE–3 ABNORMAL TORQUE Same as alarm No. 754 (for the third spindle)
ALM
390
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
D The details of spindle The details of spindle alarm No. 750 are displayed in the diagnosis display
alarm No.750 (No. 409) as shown below.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
409 SPE S2E S1E SHE
#3 (SPE) 0 : In the spindle serial control, the serial spindle parameters fulfill the
spindle unit startup conditions.
1 : In the spindle serial control, the serial spindle parameters do not fulfill
the spindle unit startup conditions.
#2 (S2E) 0 : The second spindle is normal during the spindle serial control startup.
1 : The second spindle was detected to have a fault during the spindle
serial control startup.
#1 (S1E) 0 : The first spindle is normal during the spindle serial control startup.
1 : The first spindle was detected to have a fault during the spindle axis
serial control startup.
#0 (SHE) 0 : The serial communications module in the CNC is normal.
1 : The serial communications module in the CNC was detected to have a
fault.
4800 ZONE : PUNCHING INHIBITED 1 When a safety zone check was executed, a punch command was
specified in area 1 where punching is inhibited.
4801 ZONE : PUNCHING INHIBITED 2 When a safety zone check was executed, a punch command was
specified in area 2 where punching is inhibited.
4802 ZONE : PUNCHING INHIBITED 3 When a safety zone check was executed, a punch command was
specified in area 3 where punching is inhibited.
4803 ZONE : PUNCHING INHIBITED 4 When a safety zone check was executed, a punch command was
specified in area 4 where punching is inhibited.
4810 ZONE : ENTERING INHIBITED 1 +X When a safety zone check was executed, the machine moving in the
positive X direction entered area 1 into which entry is inhibited.
4811 ZONE : ENTERING INHIBITED 1 When a safety zone check was executed, the machine moving in the
–X negative X direction entered area 1 into which entry is inhibited.
4812 ZONE : ENTERING INHIBITED 2 +X When a safety zone check was executed, the machine moving in the
positive X direction entered area 2 into which entry is inhibited.
4813 ZONE : ENTERING INHIBITED 2 When a safety zone check was executed, the machine moving in the
–X negative X direction entered area 2 into which entry is inhibited.
4814 ZONE : ENTERING INHIBITED 3 +X When a safety zone check was executed, the machine moving in the
positive X direction entered area 3 into which entry is inhibited.
4815 ZONE : ENTERING INHIBITED 3 When a safety zone check was executed, the machine moving in the
–X negative X direction entered area 3 into which entry is inhibited.
4816 ZONE : ENTERING INHIBITED 4 +X When a safety zone check was executed, the machine moving in the
positive X direction entered area 4 into which entry is inhibited.
4817 ZONE : ENTERING INHIBITED 4 When a safety zone check was executed, the machine moving in the
–X negative X direction entered area 4 into which entry is inhibited.
4830 ZONE : ENTERING INHIBITED 1 +Y When a safety zone check was executed, the machine moving in the
positive X direction entered area 1 into which entry is inhibited.
391
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
4831 ZONE : ENTERING INHIBITED 1 When a safety zone check was executed, the machine moving in the
–Y negative Y direction entered area 1 into which entry is inhibited.
4832 ZONE : ENTERING INHIBITED 2 +Y When a safety zone check was executed, the machine moving in the
positive Y direction entered area 2 into which entry is inhibited.
4833 ZONE : ENTERING INHIBITED 2 When a safety zone check was executed, the machine moving in the
–Y negative Y direction entered area 2 into which entry is inhibited.
4834 ZONE : ENTERING INHIBITED 3 +Y When a safety zone check was executed, the machine moving in the
positive Y direction entered area 3 into which entry is inhibited.
4835 ZONE : ENTERING INHIBITED 3 When a safety zone check was executed, the machine moving in the
–Y negative Y direction entered area 3 into which entry is inhibited.
4836 ZONE : ENTERING INHIBITED 4 +Y When a safety zone check was executed, the machine moving in the
positive Y direction entered area 4 into which entry is inhibited.
4837 ZONE : ENTERING INHIBITED 4 When a safety zone check was executed, the machine moving in the
–Y negative Y direction entered area 4 into which entry is inhibited.
4870 AUTO SETTING FEED ERROR The feed rate of safety zone auto setting is other than the parameter
value (No. 16538, No. 16539).
4871 AUTO SETTING PIECES ERROR In safety zone auto setting, the safety zone pieces are not correct. Or
the position detector has gone wrong, please tell your machine tool
builder.
4872 AUTO SETTING COMMAND M code, S code or T code is specified with safety zone auto setting
ERROR command (G32).
G32 is specified in the nibbling mode, in the cutter compensation, in
the rotation mode or the scaling mode.
(12) System alarms (These alarms cannot be reset with reset key.)
900 ROM PARITY A parity error occurred in the CNC, macro, or servo ROM. Correct
the contents of the flash ROM having the displayed number.
910 SRAM PARITY : (BYTE 0) A RAM parity error occurred in the part program storage RAM. Clear
replace
the RAM, or re lace the SRAM module or motherboard. Subse-
911 SRAM PARITY : (BYTE 1) quently, re–set the parameters and all other data.
912 DRAM PARITY : (BYTE 0) A RAM parity error occurred in the DRAM module. Replace the
DRAM module.
mod le
913 DRAM PARITY : (BYTE 1)
914 DRAM PARITY : (BYTE 2)
915 DRAM PARITY : (BYTE 3)
916 DRAM PARITY : (BYTE 4)
917 DRAM PARITY : (BYTE 5)
918 DRAM PARITY : (BYTE 6)
919 DRAM PARITY : (BYTE 7)
920 SERVO ALARM (1–4 AXIS) Servo alarm (first to fourth axis). A watchdog alarm condition oc-
curred, or a RAM parity error occurred in the axis control card.
Replace the axis control card.
921 SERVO ALARM (5–8 AXIS) Servo alarm (fifth to eighth axis). A watchdog alarm condition oc-
curred, or a RAM parity error occurred in the axis control card.
Replace the axis control card.
392
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
393
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
A.2
LIST OF ALARMS
(PMC)
ER00 PROGRAM DATA The sequence program in the ROM is not written correctly.
ERROR(ROM) (solution) Please exchange ROM for the sequence program.
ER01 PROGRAM DATA The sequence program in the debugging RAM is defective.
ERROR(RAM) (solution) Please clear the debugging RAM and input LADDER again.
The debugging RAM is not installed though the RAM is selected.
(solution) Please install the debugging RAM or install ROM for sequence program
and select ROM with K17#3=0.
ER02 PROGRAM SIZE OVER The size of sequence program exceeds the maximum size of LADDER(PMC–RC
only).
(solution) Please change MAX LADDER AREA SIZE at the SYSPRM screen and
restart the system.
ER03 PROGRAM SIZE The size of sequence program exceeds the option specification size.
ERROR(OPTION) (solution) Please increase the option specification size.
Or, reduce the size of sequence program.
ER04 PMC TYPE UNMATCH The PMC model setting of the sequence program is not corresponding to an actual
model.
(solution) Please change the PMC model setting by the offline programmer.
ER05 PMC MODULE TYPE The module type of the PMC engine is not correct.
ERROR
(solution) Please exchange the module of PMC engine for a correct one.
ER10 OPTION AREA NOTHING The management software for the PMC–RB has not been transferred.
(series name) (solution) The software installation is not consistent with the order. Contact FANUC.
ER11 OPTION AREA NOTHING The management software for the PMC C board has not been transferred.
(series name) (solution) The software installation is not consistent with the order. Contact FANUC.
ER12 OPTION AREA ERROR The series of the management software for the PMC–RB differs between BASIC and
(series name) OPTION.
(solution) Contact FANUC.
ER13 OPTION AREA ERROR The series of the management software for the PMC C board differs between BASIC
(series name) and OPTION.
(solution) Contact FANUC.
ER14 OPTION AREA VERSIION The edition of the management software for the PMC–RB differs between BASIC
ERROR (series name) and OPTION.
(solution) Contact FANUC.
ER15 OPTION AREA VERSIION The edition of the management software for the PMC C board differs between BASIC
ERROR (series name) and OPTION.
(solution) Contact FANUC.
394
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
ER18 PROGRAM DATA ERROR Transferring the sequence program from offline programmer was interrupted by the
BY I/O power off etc.
(solution) Please clear the sequence program and transfer the sequence program
again.
ER19 LADDER DATA ERROR Editing the LADDER was interrupted by the power off or by the switch to the CNC
screen by the function key etc.
(solution) Please edit LADDER once on PMC.
Or, please input LADDER again.
ER20 SYMBOL/COMMENT Editing the symbol and comment was interrupted by the power off or by the switch to
DATA ERROR the CNC screen by the function key etc.
(solution) Please edit symbol and comment once on PMC.
Or, please input symbol and comment again.
ER21 MESSAGE DATA ERROR Editing the message data was interrupted by the power off or the switch to the CNC
screen by the function key etc.
(solution) Please edit message data once on PMC.
Or, please input message data again.
ER23 PLEASE TURN OFF POW- There is a change in setting LADDER MAX AREA SIZE etc.
ER (solution) Please restart the system to make the change effective.
ER24 LADDER, LANGUAGE The C program area overlaps the ladder program area.
AREA OVERLAP (solution) Adjust the address range assigned to C programs.
ER25 SOFTWARE VERSION The PMC–RB management software editions are inconsistent.
ERROR (PMCAOPT) (solution) Contact FANUC.
ER32 NO I/O DEVICE Any DI/DO unit of I/O Unit or the connection unit etc. is not connected. When built–in
I/O card is connected, this message is not displayed.
(solution) When built–in I/O card is used:
Please confirm whether the built–in I/O card is certainly connected with.
When I/O Link is used:
Please confirm whether the DI/DO units turning on. Or please confirm
the connection of the cable.
ER34 SLC ERROR(xx) The communication with the DI/DO units of the xx group failed.
(solution) Please confirm the connection of the cable connected to the DI/DO
units of the xx group.
Please confirm whether the DI/DO units turned on earlier than CNC and
PMC. Or, please exchange the module of PMC engine on the DI/DO
units of the xx group
395
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
ER36 TOO MUCH INPUT DATA The number of the input data in the xx group exceeded the max. The data, which
IN GROUP(xx) exceed 32 bytes, become ineffective.
(solution) Please refer to the following for the number of the data for each group.
“FANUC I/O Unit–MODEL A connecting and maintenance manual”
(B–61813E)
“FANUC I/O Unit–MODEL B connecting manual”(B–62163E)
ER38 MAX SETTING OUTPUT The assignment data for a group exceeds 128 bytes.
DATA OVER(xx) (The assignment data of output side of xx group or later become ineffective.)
(solution) Please reduce the assignment data to 128 bytes or less for the number
of
the output data of each group.
ER39 MAX SETTING INPUT The assignment data for a group exceeds 128 bytes.
DATA OVER(xx) (The assignment data of input side of xx group or later become infective.)
(Solution) Please reduce the assignment data to 128 bytes or less for the number
of
the input data of each goup.
WN01 LADDER MAX SIZE The MAX LADDER AREA SIZE in the system parameter is illegal.
ERROR (solution) Set the correct value to MAX LADDER AREA SIZE and restart the sys-
tem.
WN03 ABORT NC–WINDOW/ LADDER was stopped while CNC and PMC were communicating.
EXIN The functional instruction WINDR, WINDW, EXIN, DISPB, and etc. may not work nor-
mally.
(solution) When restarting the system, this alarm will be released. Execute the
sequence program(Press RUN key) after confirming whether there is a
problem in LADDER or not.
WN04 UNAVAIL EDIT MODULE The LADDER editing module cannot be recognized.(PMC–RAx/RBxx=1 to 3)
(solution) Please confirm the slot position installed.
Please confirm the installed module.
WN05 PMC TYPE NO CONVER- A ladder program for the PMC–RA3/RA5 was transferred to the PMC–RB5.
SION (solution) Correct the ladder type.
WN06 TASK STOPPED BY DE- Some user tasks are stopped by break point of the debugging function.
BUG FUNC
WN07 LADDER SP ERROR When functional instruction CALL(SUB65) or CALLU(SUB66) was executed, the stack
(STACK) of the LADDER overflowed.
(solution) Please reduce the nesting of the subprogram to 8 or less.
WN18 ORIGIN ADDRESS The LANGUAGE ORIGIN address of the system parameter is wrong
ERROR (solution) Please set the address of symbol RC_CTLB_INIT in the map file to the
LANGUAGE ORIGIN of the system parameter.
396
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
WN21 COMMON MEM. ENTRY GDT ENTRY of the common memory is out of range.
ERROR (solution) Please correct the address of GDT ENTRY of the common memory in the
link control statement.
WN23 TASK COUNT OVER The number of user tasks exceeds 16.
(solution) Please confirm TASK COUNT in the link control statement. When the
number of tasks is changed, it is necessary to correct the link control
statement, build file and the composition of the files to be linked.
WN24 TASK ENTRY ADDR The selector of the entry address to the user task is out of range.
ERROR (solution) Please correct the table of GDT in build file to the value within
32(20H)–95(5FH).
WN25 DATA SEG ENTRY The entry address of the data segment is out of range.
ERROR (solution) Please correct DATA SEGMENT GDT ENTRY in the link control statement
and the table of GDT in build file within 32(20H)–95(5FH).
WN26 USER TASK PRIORITY The priority of the user task is out of range.
ERROR (solution) Please correct the TASK LEVEL in link control statement within the
range of 10–99 or –1.
Note: Only one task can have TASK LEVEL –1 (including LADDER
LEVEL 3).
WN27 CODE SEG TYPE ERROR The code segment type is illegal. The code segment of RENAMESEG in the binding
control file is wrong.
(solution) Please correct the entry of the code segment in the link control statement
to correspond to the entry in the build file.
WN28 DATA SEG TYPE ERROR The data segment type is illegal. The data segment of RENAMESEG in the binding con-
trol file is wrong.
(solution) Please correct the entry of the code segment in the link control statement
to correspond to the entry in the build file.
WN29 COMMON MEM SEG The segment type of common memory is illegal. The segment of RENAMESEG in the
TYPE ERROR building control file of the common memory is wrong.
(solution) Please correct the entry of common memory in the link control statement
to correspond to the entry in the build file.
WN30 IMPOSSIBLE ALLOCATE The memories for the data and stack etc. cannot be allocated.
MEM. (solution) Please confirm whether the value of code segment in build file and USER
GDT ADDRESS in link control statement is correct or not.
Or please reduce the value of MAX LADDER AREA SIZE of the system
parameter and the size of the stack in link control statement at the least
397
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
WN33 LNK CONTROL VER. ER- A link control statement data version error occurred.
ROR (Solution) Correct the link control statement in the C program.
WN34 LOAD MODULE COUNT The number of independent load modules exceeds eight.
OVER (solution) Decrease the number of independent load modules to eight or small
er.
WN35 CODE AREA OUT OF The specified code area is beyond the address range.
RANGE (solution) Correct the C program.
WN36 LANGUAGE SIZE ERROR The size of a C program exceeds the option size.
(OPTION) (solution) Decrease the size of the C program.
WN40 PROGRAM DATA ERROR Transfer of a C program was interrupted by, for example, a power failure.
BY I/O (LANG.) (solution) Clear the C program, then transfer the C program again.
NOTE
Alarms WN17 to WN42 indicate errors related to PMC user
C programs.
398
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
2 PC030 RAM PARITY aa:bb A RAM parity error occurred in the PMC.
aa and bb indicate internal error code.
Solution)
Replace the motherboard, then check whether the error recurs. If the error still
occurs even after the replacement of the motherboard, report the conditions un-
der which the error occurred (system configuration, operation, time and frequen-
cy of error occurrences, etc.) and the indicated internal error code to FANUC.
3 PC050 NMI SLC aa:bb A communication error occurred in the I/O Link.
aa and bb indicate internal error code.
Solution)
(1) Check whether the I/O assignment data and the actual I/O equipment con-
nection match.
(2) Check whether the cables are connected correctly.
(3) According to ”FANUC I/O Unit–MODEL A Connection and Maintenance
Manual” (B–61813E) or ”FANUC I/O Unit–MODEL B Connection manual”
(B–62163E), check for an error in the cable specifications.
(4) Replace the I/O unit interface module, cable, or motherboard. Then, check
whether the error still occurs.
399
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
Solution)
Check the correspondence between the CALL/CALLU instruction and SPE
instruction. If the error cannot be located, report the conditions under which the
error occurred and the ladder program to FANUC.
Solution)
Replace the motherboard, then check whether the error recurs. If the error still
occurs even after the replacement of the motherboard, report the conditions un-
der which the error occurred (system configuration, operation, time and frequen-
cy of error occurrences, etc.) to FANUC.
2 PC130 RAM PRTY aa A parity error occurred in user RAM or DRAM on the C language board.
xxxxyyyyyy aa : RAM parity error occurrence information
xxxx : Segment selector where the system error occurred
STATUS LED jL yyyyyy : Offset address at which the system error occurred
400
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
7 PC199 ROM PARITY eeeeeeee A parity error occurred in system ROM on the C language board.
STATUS LED Ll eeeeeeee : ROM parity error information
COM FUNCTION MISSING The funcitonal instruction COM (SUB29) is not correctly dealt with.
Correspondence of COM and COME (SUB29) is incorrect.
Or, the number of coil controlled by COM is specified by the model which the number
cannot be specified.
EDIT BUFFER OVER There in no empty area of the buffer for the editing.
(solution) Please reduce NET under editing.
END FUNCTION MISSING Functional instruction END1,END2,END3 and END do not exist. Or, there are error net
in END1,END2,END3,END.
Or, order of END1,END2,END3, and END is not correct.
ILLEGAL FUNCTION NO. The wrong number of the functional instruction is searched.
HORIZONTAL LINE ILLEGAL The horizontal line of the net is not connected.
ILLEGAL NET CLEARED Because the power had been turn off while editing LADDER, some net under editing
was cleared.
NET TOO LARGE The input net is larger than the editing buffer.
(solution) Please reduce the net under editing.
401
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
PLEASE KEY IN SUB NO. Please input the number of the functional instruction.
(solution) If you do not input the functional instruction, please push soft key “FUNC”
again.
PROGRAM MODULE NOTHING You tried to edit though there was neither RAM for debugging nor ROM for sequence
program.
RELAY OR COIL NOTHING The relay or the coil does not suffice.
SYMBOL DATA DUPLICATE The same symbol name is defined in other place.
1ST LEVEL EXECUTE TIME The 1st level of LADDER is too large to complete execution in time.
OVER (solution) Please reduce the 1st level of LADDER.
402
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
I/O LIST ERROR nn An error occurred in directory read processing from FD Cassette.
nn= 20 The state of the interface is not correct.
(solution) Please confirm the connection of the cable. Please confirm
setting of the baud rate etc.
ADDRESS IS OUT OF RANGE The data transferred to the address out of the PMC debugging RAM area.
(xxxxxx) xxxxxx : Transferred address.
(solution) Please confirm the address of the transferring data.
LADDER : Please confirm the model setting.
C language : Please confirm setting the address in the link control statement and
build file.
403
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
A.3
SPINDLE ALARMS
(SERIAL SPINDLE) NOTE
Er–xx is not displayed on the screen.
404
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
Alarm
No. Message Meaning Description Remedy
No.
“A” Program ROM Detects that control program is Install normal program
display abnormality not started (due to program ROM
(not installed) ROM not installed, etc.)
7n01 SPN_n_ : MOTOR AL–01 Motor Detects motor speed exceed- Check load status.
OVERHEAT overheat ing specified speed excessive- Cool motor then reset
ly. alarm.
7n02 SPN_n_ : EX SPEED ER- AL–02 Excessive Detects motor speed exceed- Check load status.
ROR speed devi- ing specified speed excessive- Reset alarm.
ation ly.
7n03 SPN_n_ : FUSE ON DC AL–03 DC link sec- Detects that fuse F4 in DC link Check power transistors,
LINK BLOWN tion fuse section is blown (models 30S and so forth.
blown and 40S). Replace fuse.
7n04 SPN_n_ : INPUT FUSE/ AL–04 Input fuse Detects blown fuse (F1 to F3), Replace fuse.
POWER blown. open phase or momentary fail- Check open phase and
FAULT Input power ure of power (models 30S and power supply regenerative
open phase. 40S). circuit operation.
7n05 SPN_n_ : POWER SUP- AL–05 Control power Detects that control power Check for control power
PLY FUSE supply fuse supply fuse AF2 or AF3 is supply short circuit .
BLOWN blown blown (models 30S and 40S). Replace fuse.
405
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
Alarm
No. Message Meaning Description Remedy
No.
7n07 SPN_n_ : OVERSPEED AL–07 Excessive Detects that motor rotation has Reset alarm.
speed exceeded 115% of its rated
speed.
7n08 SPN_n_ : HIGH VOLT IN- AL–08 High input volt- Detects that switch is flipped to Flip switch to 230 VAC.
PUT POWER age 200 VAC when input voltage is
230 VAC or higher (models
30S and 40S).
7n09 SPN_n_ : OVERHEAT AL–09 Excessive Detects abnormal temperature Cool radiator then reset
MAIN CIRCUIT load on main rise of power transistor radia- alarm.
circuit section tor.
7n10 SPN_n_ : LOW VOLT IN- AL–10 Low input volt- Detects drop in input power Remove cause, then reset
PUT POWER age supply voltage. alarm.
7n11 SPN_n_ : OVERVOLT AL–11 Overvoltage in Detects abnormally high direct Remove cause, then reset
POW CIRCUIT DC link sec- current power supply voltage alarm.
tion in power circuit section.
7n12 SPN_n_ : OVERCUR- AL–12 Overcurrent in Detects flow of abnormally Remove cause, then reset
RENT POW DC link sec- large current in direct current alarm.
CIRCUIT tion section of power cirtcuit
7n13 SPN_n_ : DATA AL–13 CPU internal Detects abnormality in CPU in- Remove cause, then reset
MEMORY data memory ternal data memory. This alarm.
FAULT CPU abnormality check is made only when pow-
er is turned on.
7n15 SPN_n_ : SP SWITCH AL–15 Spindle Detects incorrect switch se- Check sequence.
CONTROL switch/output quence in spindle switch/out-
ALARM switch alarm put switch operation.
7n16 SPN_n_ : RAM FAULT AL–16 RAM ab- Detects abnormality in RAM Remove cause, then reset
normality for external data. This check is alarm.
made only when power is
turned on.
7n18 SPN_n_ : SUMCHECK AL–18 Program ROM Detects program ROM data er- Remove cause, then reset
ERROR PGM sum check er- ror.This check is made only alarm.
DATA ror when power is turned on.
7n19 SPN_n_ : EX OFFSET AL–19 Excessive U Detects excessive U phase Remove cause, then reset
CURRENT U phase current current detection ciucuit offset. alarm.
detection cir- This check is made only when
cuit offset power is turned on.
7n20 SPN_n_ : EX OFFSET AL–20 Excessive V Detects excessive V phase Remove cause, then reset
CURRENT V phase current current detection circuit offset. alarm.
detection cir- This check is made only when
cuit offset power is turned on.
7n24 SPN_n_ : SERIAL AL–24 Serial transfer Detects serial transfer data er- Remove cause, then reset
TRANSFER data error ror (such as NC power supply alarm.
ERROR turned off, etc.)
7n25 SPN_n_ : SERIAL AL–25 Serial data Detects that serial data trans- Remove cause, then reset
TRANSFER transfer fer has stopped. alarm.
STOP stopped
406
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
Alarm
No. Message Meaning Description Remedy
No.
7n26 SPN_n_ : DISCONNECT AL–26 Disconnection Detects abnormality in position Remove cause, then reset
C–VELO DE- of speed coder signal(such as uncon- alarm.
TECT detection sig- nected cable and parameter
nal for Cs con- setting error).
touring control
7n27 SPN_n_ : DISCONNECT AL–27 Position coder Detects abnormality in position Remove cause, then reset
POS–CODER signal discon- coder signal (such as uncon- alarm.
nection nected cable and adjustment
error).
7n28 SPN_n_ : DISCONNECT AL–28 Disconnection Detects abnormality in position Remove cause, then reset
C–POS DE- of position detection signal for Cs con- alarm.
TECT detection sig- touring control (such as uncon-
nal for Cs con- nected cable and adjustment
touring control error).
7n29 SPN_n_ : SHORTTIME AL–29 Short–time Detects that overload has Remove cause, then reset
OVERLOAD overload been continuously applied for alarm.
some period of time (such as
restraining motor shaft in posi-
tioning).
7n30 SPN_n_ : OVERCUR- AL–30 Input circuit Detects overcurrent flowing in Remove cause, then reset
RENT POW overcurrent input circuit. alarm.
CIRCUIT
7n31 SPN_n_ : MOTOR LOCK AL–31 Speed detec- Detects that motor cannot ro- Remove cause, then reset
OR V–SIG LOS tion signal dis- tate at specified speed or it is alarm.
connection detected that the motor is
motor restraint clamped. (but rotates at very
alarm or motor slow speed or has stopped).
is clamped. (This includes checking of
speed detection signal cable.)
7n32 SPN_n_ : RAM FAULT AL–32 Abnormality in Detects abnormality in RAM in- Remove cause, then reset
SERIAL LSI RAM inside side the LSI used for serial alarm.
the LSI used data transfer. This check is
for serial data made only when power is
transfer. This turned on.
check is made
only when
power is
turned on.
7n33 SPN_n_ : SHORTAGE AL–33 Insufficient DC Detects insufficient charging of Remove cause, then reset
POWER link section direct current power supply alarm.
CHARGE charging voltage in power circuit section
when magnetic contactor in
amplifier is turned on (such as
open phase and defectifve
charging resistor).
7n34 SPN_n_ : PARAMETER AL–34 Parameter Detects parameter data set Set correct data.
SETTING ER- data setting beyond allowable range of val-
ROR beyond allow- ues.
able range of
values
407
A. ALARM LIST APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
Alarm
No. Message Meaning Description Remedy
No.
7n35 SPN_n_ : EX SETTING AL–35 Excessive Detects gear ratio data set be- Set correct data.
GEAR RATIO gear ratio data yond allowable range of val-
setting ues.
7n36 SPN_n_ : OVERFLOW AL–36 Error counter Detects error counter overflow. Correct cause, then reset
ERROR overflow alarm.
COUNTER
7n37 SPN_n_ : SPEED DE- AL–37 Speed detec- Detects incorrect setting of pa- Set correct data.
TECT PAR. tor parameter rameter for number of speed
ERROR setting error detection pulses.
7n39 SPN_n_ : 1–ROT Cs AL–39 Alarm for indi- Detects 1–rotaion signal Make 1–rotaion signal ad-
SIGNAL ER- cating failure detection failure in Cs contour- justment.
ROR in detecting ing contorl. Check cable shield status.
1–rotation sig-
nal for Cs con-
touring control
7n40 SPN_n_ : NO 1–ROT Cs AL–40 Alarm for indi- Detects that 1–rotation signal Make 1–rotaion signal ad-
SIGNAL DE- cating 1–rota- has not occurred in Cs con- justment.
TECT tion signal for touring control.
Cs contouring
control not de-
tected
7n41 SPN_n_ : 1–ROT POS– AL–41 Alarm for indi- Detects failure in detecting Make signal adjustment for
CODER ER- cating failure position coder 1–rotation sig- signal conversion circuit.
ROR in detecting nal. Check cable shield status.
position coder
1–rotaion sig-
nal.
7n42 SPN_n_ : NO 1–ROT. AL–42 Alarm for indi- Detects that position coder Make 1–rotation signal ad-
POS–CODER cating position 1–rotation signal has not is- justment for signal conver-
DETECT coder 1–rota- sued. sion circuit.
tion signal not
detected
7n43 SPN_n_ : DISCON. PC AL–43 Alarm for indi- Detects that main spindle posi- Check that main spindle
FOR DIF. SP. cating discon- tion coder signal used for dif- position coder signal is
MOD. nection of ferential speed mode is not connected to connector
position coder connected yet (or is discon- CN12.
signal for dif- nected).
ferential speed
mode
7n46 SPN_n_ : SCREW AL–46 Alarm for indi- Detects failure in detecting Make 1–rotation signal ad-
1–ROT POS– cating failure position coder 1–rotation sig- justment for signal conver-
COD. ALARM in detecting nasl in thread cutting opera- sion circuit.
position coder tion. Check cable shield status.
1–rotation sig-
nal in thread
cutting opera-
tion.
408
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX A. ALARM LIST
Alarm
No. Message Meaning Description Remedy
No.
7n47 SPN_n_ : POS–CODER AL–47 Position coder Detects incorrect position cod- Make signal adjustment for
SIGNAL AB- signal ab- er signal count operation. signal conversion circuit.
NORMAL normality Check cable shield status.
7n49 SPN_n_ : HIGH CONV. AL–49 The converted Detects that speed of other Calculate differential
DIF. SPEED differential spindle converted to speed of speed by multiplying speed
speed is too local spindle has exceeded al- of other spindle by gear ra-
high. lowable limit in differential tio. Check if calculated val-
mode. ue is not greater than maxi-
mum speed of motor.
7n50 SPN_n_ : SPNDL CON- AL–50 Excessive Detects that speed command Calculate motor speed by
TROL OVER- speed com- calculation value exceeded al- multiplying specified
SPEED mand calcula- lowable range in spindle syn- spindle speed by gear ra-
tion value in chronization control. tio. Check if calculated val-
spindle syn- ue is not greater than maxi-
chronization mum speed of motor.
control
7n51 SPN_n_ : LOW VOLT DC AL–51 Undervoltage Detects that DC power supply Remove cause, then reset
LINK at DC link sec- voltage of power circuit has alarm.
tion dropped (due to momentary
power failure or loose contact
of magnetic contactor).
7n52 SPN_n_ : ITP SIGNAL AL–52 ITP signal ab- Detects abnormality in syn- Replace servo amp. PCB.
ABNORMAL I normality I chronization signal (ITP signal
) used in software.
7n53 SPN_n_ : ITP SIGNAL AL–53 ITP signal ab- Detects abnormality in syn- Replace servo amp. PCB.
ABNORMAL II normality II chronization signal (ITP sig-
nal) used in hardware.
7n56 SPN_n_ : INNER COOL- AL–56 The cooling The cooling fan in the control Check the turning state of
ING FAN STOP fan in the unit circuit section stopped. the cooling fan. Replace
stopped. the cooling fan.
7n57 SPN_n_ : EX DECEL- AL–57 Deceleration Abnormal current flowed Check the selection of the
ERATION power is too through the regenerative resis- regenerative resistor. Al-
POWER high. tor. ternatively, check whether
the cooling fan motor is ro-
tating.
7n58 SPN_n_ : OVERLOAD IN AL–58 Overload on The temperature of the radia- Eliminate the cause, then
PSM the PSM main tor of the main circuit has in- reset the alarm.
circuit creased abnormally. (Cooling
fan failure, dirt in the cooling
fan, overload operation, etc.)
7n59 SPN_n_ : COOLING FAN AL–59 The PSM cool- The cooling fan of the control Check the turning state of
STOP IN PSM ing fan circuit section stopped. the cooling fan. Replace
stopped. the cooling fan.
409
B. LIST OF MAINTENANCE PARTS APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
B
410
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX B. LIST OF MAINTENANCE PARTS
B.1
MAINTENANCE PARTS
411
C. BOOT SYSTEM APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
C BOOT SYSTEM
412
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX C. BOOT SYSTEM
C.1 The boot system load the CNC system software (flash RAM→DRAM),
then starts it so that software can be executed.
OVERVIEW The boot system provides the following maintenance functions for the
CNC:
(1) Registering a file in flash ROM
⋅ Reads a file from a memory card, in FAT format, into flash ROM.
(2) Checking a file (series and edition) in flash ROM
(3) Deleting a file from flash ROM
(4) Batch saving and restoration of files of parameters and programs
backed up by battery (SRAM area), to and from a memory card
(5) Saving a file in flash ROM to a memory card
(6) Formatting of a memory card
(7) Deleting a file from a memory card
This manual describes the activation of the boot system, as well as the
screen displays and operation for the functions listed above.
CAUTION
This control unit supports the use of a memory card as an
input/output device. When a flash card is used, however,
data can be written to a FANUC–recommended card only.
Data can be read in the same way as with an ordinary SRAM
card, provided the data has been saved in FAT format. Note
that, when a flash card is used, the card capacity is reduced
by 128KB.
See the order list for details of the supported memory card
types.
Hold down the two keys until the boot system screen appears.
If soft keys are not provided (for example, when a touch pad is being
used), use the MDI numeric keys. Hold down the 6 and 7
keys until the boot system screen appears.
± ± ± ± ± ± ±
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
413
C. BOOT SYSTEM APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
2 When the flash memory does not contain a file required to start the
CNC
Immediately after the CNC is turned on, the boot system starts
transferring files from flash ROM to DRAM. If, for some reason, a
file required to start the CNC (NC basic) is not in flash ROM or has
been destroyed, the boot system is automatically started.
C.1.2 The boot system organizes files in flash ROM into two main groups :
System Files and User system files and user files. These two file types have the following
characteristics :
Files
D User files PMC sequence program (ladder), P–CODE macro program, and other
user–created files
C.1.3 When CAP–II board or LCB (loader control board) is mounted on the
Boot Slot CNC, we have to access to SRAM that mounted on additional board. So,
the boot system displays BOOT SLOT CONFIGURATION screen that
Configuration Screen to select a access board.
D
414
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX C. BOOT SYSTEM
C.2 When the boot system is first started, the MAIN MENU screen is
displayed. This screen is described below :
SCREEN
CONFIGURATION
AND OPERATING
PROCEDURE
D
(9) 10.END
(1) : Screen title. The series and edition of the boot system appear at
the right end.
(2) : Function for writing data to flash ROM.
(3) : Function for checing the edition of a file in ROM.
(4) : Function for deleting a file from flash ROM.
(5) : Function for making a backup copy of the data stored on the memory
card.
(6) : Function for making a backup copy of the data in SRAM.
(7) : Function for deleting a file from a memory card.
(8) : Function for formatting a memory card.
(9) : Function for terminating the boot system and starting the CNC.
(10) : Condensed guidance or error message
D Operating procedure Press the [UP] or [DOWN] soft key to select the desired function. After
positioning the cursor to the desired function, press the [SELECT] soft
key. Before executing a function, the system my request confirmation
from the operator by having him/her press the [YES] or [NO] soft key.
D Basic operation
→ Return to
original state
415
C. BOOT SYSTEM APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
C.2.1
System Data Loading
Screen
D Description This screen is used to read a system or user file from a memory card into
flash ROM.
D Screen configuration
FILE DIRECTORY
(2) B1F1A_B.MEM
B1F1A_AI.MEM
(3) END
(1) : Screen title. The page number (n) and total number of pages (m)
are displayed, in n/m format, at the right end.
(2) : Files on the memory card
(3) : Option for returning to previous menu Message
(4) : Message
D Operating procedure 1 Position the cursor to the file to be read from the memory card and
written to flash ROM. Then, press the [SELECT] soft key.
A single page can list up to eight file names. If the memory card
contains nine or more files, the remaining files are displayed on
another page.
To display the next page, press the soft key.
To display the previous page, press the soft key. The END option
is displayed on the last page.
The END option is displayed on the last page.
2 After a file has been slected, the system asks whether that file is to be
loaded.
416
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX C. BOOT SYSTEM
3 To start loading, press the [YES] soft key. To cancel, press the [NO]
key.
D Others
1 Counter display while a file is being loaded
While a file is being loaded, the address of the data currently being
accessed is displayed.
417
C. BOOT SYSTEM APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
C.2.2
System Data Check
Screen
D Description This screen is used to list files in flash ROM, together with the
corresponding numbers of 128–KB management units in each file and the
series and edition of the software.
D Screen configuration
418
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX C. BOOT SYSTEM
D Operating procedure
1 Select the file whose details are required. For example, select “1 NC
BASIC (10).”
2 The numbers of management units in the selected file are listed,
together with the series and edition of the software in each
management unit. After checking the listed data, select the
[SELECT] soft key to return to the file selection screen.
ÁÁÁÁÁÁÁÁÁ
2 B1F1 841A 002
3 B1F1 842A 003
ÁÁÁÁÁÁÁÁÁ
4 B1F1 881A 004 Internal management–unit
ÁÁÁÁÁÁÁÁÁ
5 B1F1 882A 005 number
6 B1F1 8C1A 006 ROM number and edition
ÁÁÁÁÁÁÁÁÁ
7 B1F1 8C2A 007 Series
D Others Parity information for the system file and user file
The NC BASIC, DG SERVO, and other system files in flash ROM
contain parity information in each management unit. If the file name field
or parity field on the check screen contains a non–ASC II character or an
“@” , the flash ROM may have been destroyed or a damaged file may
have been read. Re–read the data from the memory card.
The PMC–RB, PCD 0.5M, and other user files do not contain parity
information in each management unit. A non–ASCII character or an “@”
may appear in the series/edition information. In this case, it does not
indicate that the file has been damaged.
419
C. BOOT SYSTEM APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
C.2.3
System Data Delete
Screen
D Description This screen is used to delete a user file from flash ROM.
D Screen configuration
3 To start the deletion, press the [YES] key. To cancel, press [NO].
420
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX C. BOOT SYSTEM
D Others 1 System files and user files on SYSTEM DATA DELETE screen
The system files are protected from accidental deletion. User files,
however, are not protected. Protected system files can be
overwritten from the SYSTEM DATA LOADING screen.
C.2.4
SYSTEM DATA SAVE
Screen
D Description This screen is used to write a user file in flash ROM to a memory card.
Only user files can be saved from flash ROM to a memory card. System
files cannot be saved.
D Screen configuration
421
C. BOOT SYSTEM APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
D Operating procedure 1 Position the cursor to the name of the file to be deleted. Press the
[SELECT] soft key.
2 The system displays the following confirmation message :
D Others 1 System files and user files on SYSTEM DATA SAVE screen
The SYSTEM DATA SAVE function provides a safeguard against free
copying of the system files.
User files, however, are not protected.
2 Names of saved files
Files saved from flash ROM to a memory card have the following
names :
Flash ROM File name in
Memory card
422
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX C. BOOT SYSTEM
C.2.5
SRAM DATA BACKUP
Screen
D Description This screen is used to collectively save and restore parameters, programs,
and other data, retained after the CNC power in SRAM is turned off, to
and from a memory card.
D Screen configuration Select “4 SRAM DATA BACKUP” on the SYSTEM MONITOR MAIN
MENU screen. The following screen is displayed.
423
C. BOOT SYSTEM APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
D Operating procedure
[Backing up data] 1 Select “1. SRAM BACKUP.” The following confirmation message is
displayed. The backup file name may be displayed according to the
SRAM capacity.
2 Press [YES] to start backup.
[Restoring the data] 1 Select “2. RESTORE SRAM.” The system displays the following
message. Press the [YES] key.
424
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX C. BOOT SYSTEM
0.5MB SRAM0_5A.FDB
The backup file for SRAM on the PMC–RE, CAPII, or LCB board
will have the following extension:
Board MAIN PMC–RE CAPII LCB
CAUTION
If data such as parameters was restored from a memory
card to SRAM in a system using an absolute pulse coder,
set bit 4 (APZ) of parameter No. 1815 to 0, and set the
reference point again.
425
C. BOOT SYSTEM APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
C.2.6
MEMORY CARD FILE
DELETE Screen
D Screen configuration
(1) : Screen title. Tlhe current page number (n) and the total number
of pages (m) are displayed, in n/m format, at the right end.
(2) : Files on the memory card
(3) : Option for returning to the previous menu
(4) : Message
D Operating procedure 1 Press the [SELECT] key to select the name of the file to be deleted
from the memory card.
2 The system displays the following confirmation message. Press the
[YES] key.
3 When a file has been deleted normally, display the following message.
Press the [SELECT] key.
426
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX C. BOOT SYSTEM
C.2.7
MEMORY CARD
FORMAT Function
D Description This function is used to format a memory card. Memory cards must be
formatted before they can be used for the first time or before they can be
re–used after their data has been destroyed or lost because of, for example,
battery failure.
D Operating procedure 1 From the SYSTEM MONITOR MAIN MENU screen, select “7.
MEMORY CARD FORMAT.”
2 The system displays the following confirmation message.
Press the [YES] key.
4 When a card has been formatted normally, the system display the
⋅ following message.
⋅ Press the [SELECT] key.
427
C. BOOT SYSTEM APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
C.2.8
LOAD BASIC SYSTEM
Function
D Description The function is used to terminate the boot system and activate the CNC.
D Operating procedure From the MAIN MENU screen, select “9. END.” The system displays
the “ARE YOU SURE? HIT YES OR NO” message. To terminate the
boot system and activate the CNC, press the [YES] soft key. Press the
[NO] soft key, and you will be brought back to the main menu.
If the contents of the NC BASIC SYSTEM file are found to have been
damaged or destroyed, the system returns to the processing selection
state, in exactly the same way as when the [NO] soft key is pressed.
428
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX C. BOOT SYSTEM
2 If the [NO] soft key is pressed, the system returns to the processing
selection state as shown below :
10.END
429
C. BOOT SYSTEM APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
C.3 The following table lists and explains error messages in alphabetical
order.
ERROR MESSAGES
AND REQUIRED
ACTIONS
B BOOT ROM PARITY. The contents of flash memory containing boot software was de-
PLEASE POWER OFF. stroyed. Replace the CPU card.
C CHANGE MEMORY CARD. The memory card becomes full in the middle of SRAM backup op-
AND HIT YES OR NO. eration. Replace the card with a memory card containing enough
free space.
D DELETE ERROR. An attempt to delete a file from flash ROM was unsuccessful. Retry the
HIT SELECT KEY. deletion. If the second attempt also fails, the flash ROM may have
been damaged or destroyed. Replace the flash ROM module.
DEVICE ERROR (CNC x) An attempt to write data to flash ROM was unsuccessful. Retry the
write operation. If the second attempt also fails, the flash ROM may
have been damaged or destroyed. Repalce the flash ROM module.
F FILE SAVE ERROR. An attempt to write a file to a memory card was unsuccessful. Check
HIT SELECT KEY. that the memory card is not damaged.
Note) Check that the memory card’s battery is not exhusted, that its
circuitry has not been damaged, and that it is securely inserted
into its slot.
FLASH MEMORY NO SPACE There is insufficient free flash ROM to store the selected file. Delete
any unnecessary files from flash ROM.
FLASH ROM MODULE NOT EXIST. The flash ROM module is not mounted on that CNC system. Put the
HIT SELECT. flash ROM module on the board.
I ILLEGAL FORMAT FILE The selected file cannot be read into flash memory. The selected file
or the header information for flash ROM may have been damaged or
destroyed.
ILLEGAL FROM MODULE. The flash ROM module ID is illegal. Check the drawing No. of the flash
HIT SELECT KEY. ROM module.
ILLEGAL SRAM MODULE. The SRAM module ID is illegal. Check the drawing No. of the SRAM
HIT SELECT KEY. module.
L LOADING ERROR. An error occurred while loading data into flash ROM.
HIT SELECT KEY. Do not touch the memory card while loading data.
430
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX C. BOOT SYSTEM
M MAX EXTENSION OVER. The extension number added to a file name exceeds 031. Delete any
HIT SELECT KEY. unnecessary backup files from the memory card.
MEMORY CARD BATTERY ALARM. The memory card’s battery is exhausted. Replace the battery.
HIT SELECT.
MEMORY CARD FULL. The memory card is full. Delete any unnecessary files from the
HIT SELECT KEY. memory card. Alternatively, replace the memory card with another
card having sufficient free space.
MEMORY CARD IS NOT The use of this memory card is not supported. Use only FANUC–
AVAILABLE. HIT SEL. recommended memory cards, as described in the order list.
MEMORY CARD MOUNT ERROR. The memory card could not be accessed. Check that the memory card
HIT SELECT KEY is normal.
MEMORY CARD NOT EXIST. The memory card is not inserted into its slot. Check that the memory
HIT SELECT KEY. card is pushed fully home.
MEMORY CARD PROTECTED.HIT Although writing to the memory card was selected, the write inhibit
SELECT KEY. switch is set. Disable the write inhibit switch.
Note) Check that the memory card’s battery is not exhusted, that its
circuitry has not been damaged, and that it is securely inserted
into its slot.
MEMORY CARD TYPE IS NOT Write has been attempted to an incompatible flash memory card. Use
AVAILABLE. only the flash ROM cards recommended by FANUC. Recommended
flash ROM cards are listed in the ordering list.
MEMORY CARD RESET ERROR. Access to a memory card failed. The memory card’s battery may have
HIT SELECT KEY. gone dead, the memory card may have been damaged electrically, or
the memory card may not be inserted in the slot securely.
MEMORY CARD WRITE ERROR. Access to the memory card has failed. Check whether the memory
HIT SELECT KEY. card is defective.
Note) Check that the memory card’s battery is not exhusted, that its
circuitry has not been damaged, and that it is securely inserted
into its slot.
P PLEASE FORMAT FLASH TYPE It is not possible to delete only specific files from a flash ROM card, due
CARD.HIT SEL. to the characteristics of the memory used. To delete a file it is neces-
sary to delete all files on the card, by using the FORMAT function.
R ROM PARITY ERROR: The NC BASIC is parity error. Check whether NC BASIC is in flash
NC BASIC. HIT SELECT. ROM, using SYSTEM DATA CHECK.
S SRAM DATA BACKUP ERROR. An attempt to write a backup file to a memory card failed.
HIT SELECT KEY. Check that the memory card is normal.
Note) Check that the memory card’s battery is not exhusted, that its
circuitry has not been damaged, and that it is securely inserted
into its slot.
SRAM PARITY OCCURRED. A parity error was detected during backup operation of SRAM (Cau-
PLEASE POWER OFF. tion).
431
C. BOOT SYSTEM APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
CAUTION
1 Action to be taken when an SRAM parity error is detected during backup of SRAM in the boot
system
The SRAM area of each CNC shipped from the factory is cleared and is free of parity errors.
However, shock applied to the CNC during transportation may cause a parity error in the SRAM
area. A parity error may also occur in the SRAM area when the CNC was kept switched off for
one year or longer, and the battery has been exhausted. If a parity error occurs in the SRAM
area, the data held in the SRAM area is not guaranteed. However, the CNC does not always
use the entire SRAM area. A parity error is not detected by hardware unless the part containing
the error is read. Therefore, if a parity error occurs in an area not accessed by the CNC, the
CNC may operate normally. The SRAM backup function of the boot system reads the entire
SRAM area. So, a parity error may occur in the middle of backup operation even when the CNC
has operated normally. In this case, the SRAM data of the CNC is not guaranteed, and the data
cannot be backed up using the SRAM backup function of the boot system. Nevertheless, the
CNC may operate normally. So, it is recommended that necessary data be backed up using
the Floppy Cassette or Handy File, data all clear operation be performed, then the backed up
data be restored in the CNC. Once all clear operation is performed, the parity error can be
removed. Then, the SRAM backup function of the boot system can be used.
432
B–63005EN/01 APPENDIX D. NOTATION OF MDI KEYS
D
Series 16/18/160/180–MODEL C have two types of MDI keypads : English type and Symbolic type.
The table below shows correspondence between English keys and Symbolic keys.
This manual uses English type in the text.
Therefore when a user uses Symbolic type MDI keypads and encounters an English key in the text, please refer
to the correspondence table shown below.
OFFSET/ OFFSET
CNC
CNC/MMC key
MMC
433
D. NOTATION OF MDI KEYS APPENDIX B–63005EN/01
PAGE UP key
PAGE
PAGE
PAGE DOWN key
CUSTOM
CUSTOM/GRAPH key
GRAPH
434
B–63005EN/01 Index
[A] [C]
Ac Spindle (Analog Interface), 297 C language Board, Serial Communication Board,
CAP–II Board, 130
AC spindle (serial interface), 284
Cable Clamping and Shielding, 174
Ac Spindle (Serial Interface), 285
Calculation of S analog voltage and related parame-
Address, 240 ters, 299
Adjusting Reference Position (Dog Method), 280 Clearing Alarm History, 27
Alarm 300 (Request for Reference Position Return), Clearing CAP–II Data (16i–T), 204
338 Clearing CAP–II Memory, 205
Alarm 417 (Digital Servo System is Abnormal), 339 CNC State Display, 69
Alarm 700 (Overheat at Control Side), 344 Color Setting, 96
Alarm 704 (Spindle Speed Fluctuation Detection Color Setting Screen, 96
Alarm), 340
Configuration Display of Software, 23
Alarm 749 (Serial Spindle Communication Error), 341
Configuration of PCBs, 24
Alarm 750 (Spindle Serial Link Cannot be Started),
342 Configuration of Printed Circuit Board Connectors
and Cards, 116
Alarm 85 to 87 (Reader/Puncher Interface Alarm),
329 Confirming the Parameters Required for Data Output,
180
Alarm 90 (Reference Position Return is Abnormal), Contents Displayed, 54
336
Contrast Adjustment, 100
Alarm 900 (ROM Parity Error), 345
Corrective Action for Failures, 304
Alarm 910, 911 (SRAM Parity Error), 347
Correspondence between operation mode and parame-
Alarm 912 to 919 (Dram Parity Error), 349 ters on spindle tuning screen, 293
Alarm 920, 921 (Watch Dog or RAM Parity), 350 Countermeasures Against Noise, 169
Alarm 924 (Servo Module Mounting Error), 352 Cycle Start LED Signal has Turned Off, 325
Alarm 930 (CPU Error), 353
Alarm 950 (PMC System Alarm), 354
Alarm 951 (PMC–Watch Dog Alarm), 357 [D]
Alarm 972 (NMI Alarm in Other Board), 358 Data Input/Output On the All IO Screen, 206
Alarm 973 (NMI Alarm by Unknown Cause), 359 Data Input/Output Using a Memory Card, 227
Data Sampling for Storage Type Waveform Diagnosis,
Alarm Display, 27 76
Alarm History Screen, 27 Data Server Board, 135
Alarm List, 363 Deleting File Name and Files, 204
Applicable models, 2 Deletion of External Operator Messages Record, 28
Associated Parameters, 283 Demounting a Card PCB , 146
Automatic Operation Cannot be Done, 317 Demounting a DIMM Module, 149
Automatic Setting of Standard Parameters, 296 Description of this manual, 1
Digital servo, 266
Display and operation, 1
[B] Display Method, 24, 51, 82, 245
Basic Unit, 138 Display method, 288
Boot Slot Configuration Screen, 414 Displaying Diagnostic Page, 54
i–1
Index B–63005EN/01
[G]
General, 27, 51, 280, 282
[J]
Jog Operation Cannot be Done, 310
General of Interface, 238
Graphic of Wave Diagnosis data, 74
Graphic screen (M series), 21
[K]
Graphic screen (T series), 20
Kind of Data in Sub Memory, 203
Grounding, 171
[L]
[H] List of Alarm Codes, 364
Handle Operation Cannot be Done, 314
List of Alarms (PMC), 394
Hardware, 111
List of Maintenance Parts, 410
Help Function, 51
List of Operations, 84
Help screen, 19 List of Signals by Each Mode, 264
HSSB Interface Board, 137 List of Units and Printed Circuit Boards, 138
LOAD BASIC SYSTEM Function, 428
Loader Control Board, 136
[I]
Initial Setting Servo Parameters, 267
Input and output of CAP Data (Super CAP T), 191 [M]
Input and output of data, 177 Maintenance Information Input/Output, 95
Input and Output of Each File (Super CAP M), 191 Maintenance Information Screen, 92
Input and Output of Each File (Super CAP T), 198 Maintenance of Heat Exchanger of Heat Pipe Type,
Input/Output of Conversational Data in a Lump(Super 163
CAP M), 189 Maintenance Parts, 411
Input/Output Super Cap Data, 189 MDI Unit, 140
Inputting and Outputting Floppy Files, 215 MEMORY CARD FILE DELETE Screen, 426
Inputting and Outputting Offset Data, 213 MEMORY CARD FORMAT Function, 427
i–2
B–63005EN/01 Index
i–3
Index B–63005EN/01
Soft key transition triggered by the function key Tuning S analog voltage (D/A converter), 301
i–4
Revision Record
01 Apr., ’97